blob: 84cff68576ecc9dcdf227afb0c3e30fbe6dfde61 [file] [log] [blame]
Bram Moolenaarbb5ddda2008-11-28 10:01:10 +00001*options.txt* For Vim version 7.2. Last change: 2008 Nov 25
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002
3
4 VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
5
6
7Options *options*
8
91. Setting options |set-option|
102. Automatically setting options |auto-setting|
113. Options summary |option-summary|
12
13For an overview of options see help.txt |option-list|.
14
15Vim has a number of internal variables and switches which can be set to
16achieve special effects. These options come in three forms:
17 boolean can only be on or off *boolean* *toggle*
18 number has a numeric value
19 string has a string value
20
21==============================================================================
Bram Moolenaarf75a9632005-09-13 21:20:47 +0000221. Setting options *set-option* *E764*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000023
24 *:se* *:set*
25:se[t] Show all options that differ from their default value.
26
27:se[t] all Show all but terminal options.
28
29:se[t] termcap Show all terminal options. Note that in the GUI the
30 key codes are not shown, because they are generated
31 internally and can't be changed. Changing the terminal
32 codes in the GUI is not useful either...
33
34 *E518* *E519*
35:se[t] {option}? Show value of {option}.
36
37:se[t] {option} Toggle option: set, switch it on.
38 Number option: show value.
39 String option: show value.
40
41:se[t] no{option} Toggle option: Reset, switch it off.
42
43:se[t] {option}! or
44:se[t] inv{option} Toggle option: Invert value. {not in Vi}
45
46 *:set-default* *:set-&* *:set-&vi* *:set-&vim*
47:se[t] {option}& Reset option to its default value. May depend on the
48 current value of 'compatible'. {not in Vi}
49:se[t] {option}&vi Reset option to its Vi default value. {not in Vi}
50:se[t] {option}&vim Reset option to its Vim default value. {not in Vi}
51
52:se[t] all& Set all options, except terminal options, to their
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +000053 default value. The values of 'term', 'lines' and
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000054 'columns' are not changed. {not in Vi}
55
56 *:set-args* *E487* *E521*
57:se[t] {option}={value} or
58:se[t] {option}:{value}
59 Set string or number option to {value}.
60 For numeric options the value can be given in decimal,
61 hex (preceded with 0x) or octal (preceded with '0')
62 (hex and octal are only available for machines which
63 have the strtol() function).
64 The old value can be inserted by typing 'wildchar' (by
65 default this is a <Tab> or CTRL-E if 'compatible' is
66 set). See |cmdline-completion|.
67 White space between {option} and '=' is allowed and
68 will be ignored. White space between '=' and {value}
69 is not allowed.
70 See |option-backslash| for using white space and
71 backslashes in {value}.
72
73:se[t] {option}+={value} *:set+=*
74 Add the {value} to a number option, or append the
75 {value} to a string option. When the option is a
76 comma separated list, a comma is added, unless the
77 value was empty.
78 If the option is a list of flags, superfluous flags
Bram Moolenaara5792f52005-11-23 21:25:05 +000079 are removed. When adding a flag that was already
80 present the option value doesn't change.
Bram Moolenaar899dddf2006-03-26 21:06:50 +000081 Also see |:set-args| above.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000082 {not in Vi}
83
84:se[t] {option}^={value} *:set^=*
85 Multiply the {value} to a number option, or prepend
86 the {value} to a string option. When the option is a
87 comma separated list, a comma is added, unless the
88 value was empty.
89 Also see |:set-args| above.
90 {not in Vi}
91
92:se[t] {option}-={value} *:set-=*
93 Subtract the {value} from a number option, or remove
94 the {value} from a string option, if it is there.
95 If the {value} is not found in a string option, there
96 is no error or warning. When the option is a comma
97 separated list, a comma is deleted, unless the option
98 becomes empty.
99 When the option is a list of flags, {value} must be
100 exactly as they appear in the option. Remove flags
101 one by one to avoid problems.
102 Also see |:set-args| above.
103 {not in Vi}
104
105The {option} arguments to ":set" may be repeated. For example: >
106 :set ai nosi sw=3 ts=3
107If you make an error in one of the arguments, an error message will be given
108and the following arguments will be ignored.
109
110 *:set-verbose*
111When 'verbose' is non-zero, displaying an option value will also tell where it
112was last set. Example: >
113 :verbose set shiftwidth cindent?
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +0000114< shiftwidth=4 ~
115 Last set from modeline ~
116 cindent ~
117 Last set from /usr/local/share/vim/vim60/ftplugin/c.vim ~
118This is only done when specific option values are requested, not for ":verbose
119set all" or ":verbose set" without an argument.
120When the option was set by hand there is no "Last set" message.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000121When the option was set while executing a function, user command or
122autocommand, the script in which it was defined is reported.
123Note that an option may also have been set as a side effect of setting
124'compatible'.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +0000125A few special texts:
126 Last set from modeline ~
127 Option was set in a |modeline|.
128 Last set from --cmd argument ~
129 Option was set with command line argument |--cmd| or +.
130 Last set from -c argument ~
131 Option was set with command line argument |-c|, +, |-S| or
132 |-q|.
133 Last set from environment variable ~
134 Option was set from an environment variable, $VIMINIT,
135 $GVIMINIT or $EXINIT.
136 Last set from error handler ~
137 Option was cleared when evaluating it resulted in an error.
138
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000139{not available when compiled without the +eval feature}
140
141 *:set-termcap* *E522*
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +0000142For {option} the form "t_xx" may be used to set a terminal option. This will
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000143override the value from the termcap. You can then use it in a mapping. If
144the "xx" part contains special characters, use the <t_xx> form: >
145 :set <t_#4>=^[Ot
146This can also be used to translate a special code for a normal key. For
147example, if Alt-b produces <Esc>b, use this: >
148 :set <M-b>=^[b
149(the ^[ is a real <Esc> here, use CTRL-V <Esc> to enter it)
150The advantage over a mapping is that it works in all situations.
151
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +0000152The t_xx options cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
153security reasons.
154
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000155The listing from ":set" looks different from Vi. Long string options are put
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000156at the end of the list. The number of options is quite large. The output of
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000157"set all" probably does not fit on the screen, causing Vim to give the
158|more-prompt|.
159
160 *option-backslash*
161To include white space in a string option value it has to be preceded with a
162backslash. To include a backslash you have to use two. Effectively this
163means that the number of backslashes in an option value is halved (rounded
164down).
165A few examples: >
166 :set tags=tags\ /usr/tags results in "tags /usr/tags"
167 :set tags=tags\\,file results in "tags\,file"
168 :set tags=tags\\\ file results in "tags\ file"
169
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000170The "|" character separates a ":set" command from a following command. To
171include the "|" in the option value, use "\|" instead. This example sets the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000172'titlestring' option to "hi|there": >
173 :set titlestring=hi\|there
174This sets the 'titlestring' option to "hi" and 'iconstring' to "there": >
175 :set titlestring=hi|set iconstring=there
176
Bram Moolenaar7df351e2006-01-23 22:30:28 +0000177Similarly, the double quote character starts a comment. To include the '"' in
178the option value, use '\"' instead. This example sets the 'titlestring'
179option to 'hi "there"': >
180 :set titlestring=hi\ \"there\"
181
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000182For MS-DOS and WIN32 backslashes in file names are mostly not removed. More
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000183precise: For options that expect a file name (those where environment
184variables are expanded) a backslash before a normal file name character is not
185removed. But a backslash before a special character (space, backslash, comma,
186etc.) is used like explained above.
187There is one special situation, when the value starts with "\\": >
188 :set dir=\\machine\path results in "\\machine\path"
189 :set dir=\\\\machine\\path results in "\\machine\path"
190 :set dir=\\path\\file results in "\\path\file" (wrong!)
191For the first one the start is kept, but for the second one the backslashes
192are halved. This makes sure it works both when you expect backslashes to be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000193halved and when you expect the backslashes to be kept. The third gives a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000194result which is probably not what you want. Avoid it.
195
196 *add-option-flags* *remove-option-flags*
197 *E539* *E550* *E551* *E552*
198Some options are a list of flags. When you want to add a flag to such an
199option, without changing the existing ones, you can do it like this: >
200 :set guioptions+=a
201Remove a flag from an option like this: >
202 :set guioptions-=a
203This removes the 'a' flag from 'guioptions'.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000204Note that you should add or remove one flag at a time. If 'guioptions' has
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000205the value "ab", using "set guioptions-=ba" won't work, because the string "ba"
206doesn't appear.
207
208 *:set_env* *expand-env* *expand-environment-var*
Bram Moolenaard4755bb2004-09-02 19:12:26 +0000209Environment variables in specific string options will be expanded. If the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000210environment variable exists the '$' and the following environment variable
211name is replaced with its value. If it does not exist the '$' and the name
212are not modified. Any non-id character (not a letter, digit or '_') may
213follow the environment variable name. That character and what follows is
214appended to the value of the environment variable. Examples: >
215 :set term=$TERM.new
216 :set path=/usr/$INCLUDE,$HOME/include,.
217When adding or removing a string from an option with ":set opt-=val" or ":set
218opt+=val" the expansion is done before the adding or removing.
219
220
221Handling of local options *local-options*
222
223Some of the options only apply to a window or buffer. Each window or buffer
224has its own copy of this option, thus can each have their own value. This
225allows you to set 'list' in one window but not in another. And set
226'shiftwidth' to 3 in one buffer and 4 in another.
227
228The following explains what happens to these local options in specific
229situations. You don't really need to know all of this, since Vim mostly uses
230the option values you would expect. Unfortunately, doing what the user
231expects is a bit complicated...
232
233When splitting a window, the local options are copied to the new window. Thus
234right after the split the contents of the two windows look the same.
235
236When editing a new buffer, its local option values must be initialized. Since
237the local options of the current buffer might be specifically for that buffer,
238these are not used. Instead, for each buffer-local option there also is a
239global value, which is used for new buffers. With ":set" both the local and
240global value is changed. With "setlocal" only the local value is changed,
241thus this value is not used when editing a new buffer.
242
243When editing a buffer that has been edited before, the last used window
244options are used again. If this buffer has been edited in this window, the
245values from back then are used. Otherwise the values from the window where
246the buffer was edited last are used.
247
248It's possible to set a local window option specifically for a type of buffer.
249When you edit another buffer in the same window, you don't want to keep
250using these local window options. Therefore Vim keeps a global value of the
251local window options, which is used when editing another buffer. Each window
252has its own copy of these values. Thus these are local to the window, but
253global to all buffers in the window. With this you can do: >
254 :e one
255 :set list
256 :e two
257Now the 'list' option will also be set in "two", since with the ":set list"
258command you have also set the global value. >
259 :set nolist
260 :e one
261 :setlocal list
262 :e two
263Now the 'list' option is not set, because ":set nolist" resets the global
264value, ":setlocal list" only changes the local value and ":e two" gets the
265global value. Note that if you do this next: >
266 :e one
267You will not get back the 'list' value as it was the last time you edited
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000268"one". The options local to a window are not remembered for each buffer.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000269
270 *:setl* *:setlocal*
271:setl[ocal] ... Like ":set" but set only the value local to the
272 current buffer or window. Not all options have a
273 local value. If the option does not have a local
274 value the global value is set.
275 With the "all" argument: display all local option's
276 local values.
277 Without argument: Display all local option's local
278 values which are different from the default.
279 When displaying a specific local option, show the
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +0000280 local value. For a global/local boolean option, when
281 the global value is being used, "--" is displayed
282 before the option name.
283 For a global option the global value is
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000284 shown (but that might change in the future).
285 {not in Vi}
286
Bram Moolenaar899dddf2006-03-26 21:06:50 +0000287:setl[ocal] {option}< Set the local value of {option} to its global value by
288 copying the value.
289 {not in Vi}
290
291:se[t] {option}< Set the local value of {option} to its global value by
292 making it empty. Only makes sense for |global-local|
293 options.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000294 {not in Vi}
295
296 *:setg* *:setglobal*
297:setg[lobal] ... Like ":set" but set only the global value for a local
298 option without changing the local value.
299 When displaying an option, the global value is shown.
300 With the "all" argument: display all local option's
301 global values.
302 Without argument: display all local option's global
303 values which are different from the default.
304 {not in Vi}
305
306For buffer-local and window-local options:
307 Command global value local value ~
308 :set option=value set set
309 :setlocal option=value - set
310:setglobal option=value set -
311 :set option? - display
312 :setlocal option? - display
313:setglobal option? display -
314
315
316Global options with a local value *global-local*
317
Bram Moolenaarb5bf5b82004-12-24 14:35:23 +0000318Options are global when you mostly use one value for all buffers and windows.
319For some global options it's useful to sometimes have a different local value.
320You can set the local value with ":setlocal". That buffer or window will then
321use the local value, while other buffers and windows continue using the global
322value.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000323
324For example, you have two windows, both on C source code. They use the global
325'makeprg' option. If you do this in one of the two windows: >
326 :set makeprg=gmake
327then the other window will switch to the same value. There is no need to set
328the 'makeprg' option in the other C source window too.
329However, if you start editing a Perl file in a new window, you want to use
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +0000330another 'makeprg' for it, without changing the value used for the C source
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000331files. You use this command: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000332 :setlocal makeprg=perlmake
333You can switch back to using the global value by making the local value empty: >
334 :setlocal makeprg=
335This only works for a string option. For a boolean option you need to use the
336"<" flag, like this: >
337 :setlocal autoread<
338Note that for non-boolean options using "<" copies the global value to the
339local value, it doesn't switch back to using the global value (that matters
Bram Moolenaar899dddf2006-03-26 21:06:50 +0000340when the global value changes later). You can also use: >
341 :set path<
342This will make the local value of 'path' empty, so that the global value is
343used. Thus it does the same as: >
344 :setlocal path=
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000345Note: In the future more global options can be made global-local. Using
346":setlocal" on a global option might work differently then.
347
348
349Setting the filetype
350
351:setf[iletype] {filetype} *:setf* *:setfiletype*
352 Set the 'filetype' option to {filetype}, but only if
353 not done yet in a sequence of (nested) autocommands.
354 This is short for: >
355 :if !did_filetype()
356 : setlocal filetype={filetype}
357 :endif
358< This command is used in a filetype.vim file to avoid
359 setting the 'filetype' option twice, causing different
360 settings and syntax files to be loaded.
361 {not in Vi}
362
363:bro[wse] se[t] *:set-browse* *:browse-set* *:opt* *:options*
364:opt[ions] Open a window for viewing and setting all options.
365 Options are grouped by function.
366 Offers short help for each option. Hit <CR> on the
367 short help to open a help window with more help for
368 the option.
369 Modify the value of the option and hit <CR> on the
370 "set" line to set the new value. For window and
371 buffer specific options, the last accessed window is
372 used to set the option value in, unless this is a help
373 window, in which case the window below help window is
374 used (skipping the option-window).
375 {not available when compiled without the |+eval| or
376 |+autocmd| features}
377
378 *$HOME*
379Using "~" is like using "$HOME", but it is only recognized at the start of an
380option and after a space or comma.
381
382On Unix systems "~user" can be used too. It is replaced by the home directory
383of user "user". Example: >
384 :set path=~mool/include,/usr/include,.
385
386On Unix systems the form "${HOME}" can be used too. The name between {} can
387contain non-id characters then. Note that if you want to use this for the
388"gf" command, you need to add the '{' and '}' characters to 'isfname'.
389
390NOTE: expanding environment variables and "~/" is only done with the ":set"
391command, not when assigning a value to an option with ":let".
392
393
394Note the maximum length of an expanded option is limited. How much depends on
395the system, mostly it is something like 256 or 1024 characters.
396
397 *:fix* *:fixdel*
398:fix[del] Set the value of 't_kD':
399 't_kb' is 't_kD' becomes ~
400 CTRL-? CTRL-H
401 not CTRL-? CTRL-?
402
403 (CTRL-? is 0177 octal, 0x7f hex) {not in Vi}
404
405 If your delete key terminal code is wrong, but the
406 code for backspace is alright, you can put this in
407 your .vimrc: >
408 :fixdel
409< This works no matter what the actual code for
410 backspace is.
411
412 If the backspace key terminal code is wrong you can
413 use this: >
414 :if &term == "termname"
415 : set t_kb=^V<BS>
416 : fixdel
417 :endif
418< Where "^V" is CTRL-V and "<BS>" is the backspace key
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000419 (don't type four characters!). Replace "termname"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000420 with your terminal name.
421
422 If your <Delete> key sends a strange key sequence (not
423 CTRL-? or CTRL-H) you cannot use ":fixdel". Then use: >
424 :if &term == "termname"
425 : set t_kD=^V<Delete>
426 :endif
427< Where "^V" is CTRL-V and "<Delete>" is the delete key
428 (don't type eight characters!). Replace "termname"
429 with your terminal name.
430
431 *Linux-backspace*
432 Note about Linux: By default the backspace key
433 produces CTRL-?, which is wrong. You can fix it by
434 putting this line in your rc.local: >
435 echo "keycode 14 = BackSpace" | loadkeys
436<
437 *NetBSD-backspace*
438 Note about NetBSD: If your backspace doesn't produce
439 the right code, try this: >
440 xmodmap -e "keycode 22 = BackSpace"
441< If this works, add this in your .Xmodmap file: >
442 keysym 22 = BackSpace
443< You need to restart for this to take effect.
444
445==============================================================================
4462. Automatically setting options *auto-setting*
447
448Besides changing options with the ":set" command, there are three alternatives
449to set options automatically for one or more files:
450
4511. When starting Vim initializations are read from various places. See
452 |initialization|. Most of them are performed for all editing sessions,
453 and some of them depend on the directory where Vim is started.
454 You can create an initialization file with |:mkvimrc|, |:mkview| and
455 |:mksession|.
4562. If you start editing a new file, the automatic commands are executed.
457 This can be used to set options for files matching a particular pattern and
458 many other things. See |autocommand|.
4593. If you start editing a new file, and the 'modeline' option is on, a
460 number of lines at the beginning and end of the file are checked for
461 modelines. This is explained here.
462
463 *modeline* *vim:* *vi:* *ex:* *E520*
464There are two forms of modelines. The first form:
465 [text]{white}{vi:|vim:|ex:}[white]{options}
466
467[text] any text or empty
468{white} at least one blank character (<Space> or <Tab>)
469{vi:|vim:|ex:} the string "vi:", "vim:" or "ex:"
470[white] optional white space
471{options} a list of option settings, separated with white space or ':',
472 where each part between ':' is the argument for a ":set"
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +0000473 command (can be empty)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000474
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +0000475Example:
476 vi:noai:sw=3 ts=6 ~
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000477
478The second form (this is compatible with some versions of Vi):
479
480 [text]{white}{vi:|vim:|ex:}[white]se[t] {options}:[text]
481
482[text] any text or empty
483{white} at least one blank character (<Space> or <Tab>)
484{vi:|vim:|ex:} the string "vi:", "vim:" or "ex:"
485[white] optional white space
486se[t] the string "set " or "se " (note the space)
487{options} a list of options, separated with white space, which is the
488 argument for a ":set" command
489: a colon
490[text] any text or empty
491
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +0000492Example:
493 /* vim: set ai tw=75: */ ~
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000494
495The white space before {vi:|vim:|ex:} is required. This minimizes the chance
496that a normal word like "lex:" is caught. There is one exception: "vi:" and
497"vim:" can also be at the start of the line (for compatibility with version
4983.0). Using "ex:" at the start of the line will be ignored (this could be
499short for "example:").
500
501 *modeline-local*
502The options are set like with ":setlocal": The new value only applies to the
Bram Moolenaar843ee412004-06-30 16:16:41 +0000503buffer and window that contain the file. Although it's possible to set global
504options from a modeline, this is unusual. If you have two windows open and
505the files in it set the same global option to a different value, the result
506depends on which one was opened last.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000507
Bram Moolenaar15d0a8c2004-09-06 17:44:46 +0000508When editing a file that was already loaded, only the window-local options
509from the modeline are used. Thus if you manually changed a buffer-local
510option after opening the file, it won't be changed if you edit the same buffer
511in another window. But window-local options will be set.
512
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000513 *modeline-version*
514If the modeline is only to be used for some versions of Vim, the version
515number can be specified where "vim:" is used:
516 vim{vers}: version {vers} or later
517 vim<{vers}: version before {vers}
518 vim={vers}: version {vers}
519 vim>{vers}: version after {vers}
520{vers} is 600 for Vim 6.0 (hundred times the major version plus minor).
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +0000521For example, to use a modeline only for Vim 6.0 and later:
522 /* vim600: set foldmethod=marker: */ ~
523To use a modeline for Vim before version 5.7:
524 /* vim<570: set sw=4: */ ~
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000525There can be no blanks between "vim" and the ":".
526
527
528The number of lines that are checked can be set with the 'modelines' option.
529If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is 0 no lines are checked.
530
531Note that for the first form all of the rest of the line is used, thus a line
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +0000532like:
533 /* vi:ts=4: */ ~
534will give an error message for the trailing "*/". This line is OK:
535 /* vi:set ts=4: */ ~
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000536
537If an error is detected the rest of the line is skipped.
538
539If you want to include a ':' in a set command precede it with a '\'. The
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +0000540backslash in front of the ':' will be removed. Example:
541 /* vi:set dir=c\:\tmp: */ ~
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000542This sets the 'dir' option to "c:\tmp". Only a single backslash before the
543':' is removed. Thus to include "\:" you have to specify "\\:".
544
545No other commands than "set" are supported, for security reasons (somebody
Bram Moolenaar8243a792007-05-01 17:05:03 +0000546might create a Trojan horse text file with modelines). And not all options
547can be set. For some options a flag is set, so that when it's used the
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +0000548|sandbox| is effective. Still, there is always a small risk that a modeline
Bram Moolenaar8243a792007-05-01 17:05:03 +0000549causes trouble. E.g., when some joker sets 'textwidth' to 5 all your lines
550are wrapped unexpectedly. So disable modelines before editing untrusted text.
551The mail ftplugin does this, for example.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000552
553Hint: If you would like to do something else than setting an option, you could
554define an autocommand that checks the file for a specific string. For
555example: >
556 au BufReadPost * if getline(1) =~ "VAR" | call SetVar() | endif
557And define a function SetVar() that does something with the line containing
558"VAR".
559
560==============================================================================
5613. Options summary *option-summary*
562
563In the list below all the options are mentioned with their full name and with
564an abbreviation if there is one. Both forms may be used.
565
566In this document when a boolean option is "set" that means that ":set option"
567is entered. When an option is "reset", ":set nooption" is used.
568
569For some options there are two default values: The "Vim default", which is
570used when 'compatible' is not set, and the "Vi default", which is used when
571'compatible' is set.
572
573Most options are the same in all windows and buffers. There are a few that
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000574are specific to how the text is presented in a window. These can be set to a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000575different value in each window. For example the 'list' option can be set in
576one window and reset in another for the same text, giving both types of view
577at the same time. There are a few options that are specific to a certain
578file. These can have a different value for each file or buffer. For example
579the 'textwidth' option can be 78 for a normal text file and 0 for a C
580program.
581
582 global one option for all buffers and windows
583 local to window each window has its own copy of this option
584 local to buffer each buffer has its own copy of this option
585
586When creating a new window the option values from the currently active window
587are used as a default value for the window-specific options. For the
588buffer-specific options this depends on the 's' and 'S' flags in the
589'cpoptions' option. If 's' is included (which is the default) the values for
590buffer options are copied from the currently active buffer when a buffer is
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000591first entered. If 'S' is present the options are copied each time the buffer
592is entered, this is almost like having global options. If 's' and 'S' are not
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000593present, the options are copied from the currently active buffer when the
594buffer is created.
595
Bram Moolenaar578b49e2005-09-10 19:22:57 +0000596Hidden options *hidden-options*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000597
Bram Moolenaar578b49e2005-09-10 19:22:57 +0000598Not all options are supported in all versions. This depends on the supported
599features and sometimes on the system. A remark about this is in curly braces
600below. When an option is not supported it may still be set without getting an
601error, this is called a hidden option. You can't get the value of a hidden
602option though, it is not stored.
603
604To test if option "foo" can be used with ":set" use something like this: >
605 if exists('&foo')
606This also returns true for a hidden option. To test if option "foo" is really
607supported use something like this: >
608 if exists('+foo')
609<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000610 *E355*
611A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
612
613 *'aleph'* *'al'* *aleph* *Aleph*
614'aleph' 'al' number (default 128 for MS-DOS, 224 otherwise)
615 global
616 {not in Vi}
617 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
618 feature}
619 The ASCII code for the first letter of the Hebrew alphabet. The
620 routine that maps the keyboard in Hebrew mode, both in Insert mode
621 (when hkmap is set) and on the command-line (when hitting CTRL-_)
622 outputs the Hebrew characters in the range [aleph..aleph+26].
623 aleph=128 applies to PC code, and aleph=224 applies to ISO 8859-8.
624 See |rileft.txt|.
625
626 *'allowrevins'* *'ari'* *'noallowrevins'* *'noari'*
627'allowrevins' 'ari' boolean (default off)
628 global
629 {not in Vi}
630 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
631 feature}
632 Allow CTRL-_ in Insert and Command-line mode. This is default off, to
633 avoid that users that accidentally type CTRL-_ instead of SHIFT-_ get
634 into reverse Insert mode, and don't know how to get out. See
635 'revins'.
636 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
637
638 *'altkeymap'* *'akm'* *'noaltkeymap'* *'noakm'*
639'altkeymap' 'akm' boolean (default off)
640 global
641 {not in Vi}
642 {only available when compiled with the |+farsi|
643 feature}
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +0000644 When on, the second language is Farsi. In editing mode CTRL-_ toggles
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000645 the keyboard map between Farsi and English, when 'allowrevins' set.
646
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +0000647 When off, the keyboard map toggles between Hebrew and English. This
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000648 is useful to start the Vim in native mode i.e. English (left-to-right
649 mode) and have default second language Farsi or Hebrew (right-to-left
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000650 mode). See |farsi.txt|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000651
652 *'ambiwidth'* *'ambw'*
653'ambiwidth' 'ambw' string (default: "single")
654 global
655 {not in Vi}
656 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
657 feature}
658 Only effective when 'encoding' is "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding.
659 Tells Vim what to do with characters with East Asian Width Class
660 Ambiguous (such as Euro, Registered Sign, Copyright Sign, Greek
661 letters, Cyrillic letters).
662
663 There are currently two possible values:
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +0000664 "single": Use the same width as characters in US-ASCII. This is
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000665 expected by most users.
666 "double": Use twice the width of ASCII characters.
667
668 There are a number of CJK fonts for which the width of glyphs for
669 those characters are solely based on how many octets they take in
670 legacy/traditional CJK encodings. In those encodings, Euro,
671 Registered sign, Greek/Cyrillic letters are represented by two octets,
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +0000672 therefore those fonts have "wide" glyphs for them. This is also
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000673 true of some line drawing characters used to make tables in text
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +0000674 file. Therefore, when a CJK font is used for GUI Vim or
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000675 Vim is running inside a terminal (emulators) that uses a CJK font
676 (or Vim is run inside an xterm invoked with "-cjkwidth" option.),
677 this option should be set to "double" to match the width perceived
678 by Vim with the width of glyphs in the font. Perhaps it also has
679 to be set to "double" under CJK Windows 9x/ME or Windows 2k/XP
680 when the system locale is set to one of CJK locales. See Unicode
681 Standard Annex #11 (http://www.unicode.org/reports/tr11).
682
683 *'antialias'* *'anti'* *'noantialias'* *'noanti'*
684'antialias' 'anti' boolean (default: off)
685 global
686 {not in Vi}
687 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled
688 on Mac OS X}
689 This option only has an effect in the GUI version of Vim on Mac OS X
690 v10.2 or later. When on, Vim will use smooth ("antialiased") fonts,
691 which can be easier to read at certain sizes on certain displays.
692 Setting this option can sometimes cause problems if 'guifont' is set
693 to its default (empty string).
694
695 *'autochdir'* *'acd'* *'noautochdir'* *'noacd'*
696'autochdir' 'acd' boolean (default off)
697 global
698 {not in Vi}
699 {only available when compiled with the
700 |+netbeans_intg| or |+sun_workshop| feature}
Bram Moolenaard8c00872005-07-22 21:52:15 +0000701 When on, Vim will change the current working directory whenever you
702 open a file, switch buffers, delete a buffer or open/close a window.
703 It will change to the directory containing the file which was opened
704 or selected.
705 This option is provided for backward compatibility with the Vim
706 released with Sun ONE Studio 4 Enterprise Edition.
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +0000707 Note: When this option is on some plugins may not work.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000708
709 *'arabic'* *'arab'* *'noarabic'* *'noarab'*
710'arabic' 'arab' boolean (default off)
711 local to window
712 {not in Vi}
713 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic|
714 feature}
715 This option can be set to start editing Arabic text.
716 Setting this option will:
717 - Set the 'rightleft' option, unless 'termbidi' is set.
718 - Set the 'arabicshape' option, unless 'termbidi' is set.
719 - Set the 'keymap' option to "arabic"; in Insert mode CTRL-^ toggles
720 between typing English and Arabic key mapping.
721 - Set the 'delcombine' option
722 Note that 'encoding' must be "utf-8" for working with Arabic text.
723
724 Resetting this option will:
725 - Reset the 'rightleft' option.
726 - Disable the use of 'keymap' (without changing its value).
727 Note that 'arabicshape' and 'delcombine' are not reset (it is a global
728 option.
729 Also see |arabic.txt|.
730
731 *'arabicshape'* *'arshape'*
732 *'noarabicshape'* *'noarshape'*
733'arabicshape' 'arshape' boolean (default on)
734 global
735 {not in Vi}
736 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic|
737 feature}
738 When on and 'termbidi' is off, the required visual character
739 corrections that need to take place for displaying the Arabic language
740 take affect. Shaping, in essence, gets enabled; the term is a broad
741 one which encompasses:
742 a) the changing/morphing of characters based on their location
743 within a word (initial, medial, final and stand-alone).
744 b) the enabling of the ability to compose characters
745 c) the enabling of the required combining of some characters
746 When disabled the character display reverts back to each character's
747 true stand-alone form.
748 Arabic is a complex language which requires other settings, for
749 further details see |arabic.txt|.
750
751 *'autoindent'* *'ai'* *'noautoindent'* *'noai'*
752'autoindent' 'ai' boolean (default off)
753 local to buffer
754 Copy indent from current line when starting a new line (typing <CR>
755 in Insert mode or when using the "o" or "O" command). If you do not
756 type anything on the new line except <BS> or CTRL-D and then type
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +0000757 <Esc>, CTRL-O or <CR>, the indent is deleted again. Moving the cursor
758 to another line has the same effect, unless the 'I' flag is included
759 in 'cpoptions'.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000760 When autoindent is on, formatting (with the "gq" command or when you
761 reach 'textwidth' in Insert mode) uses the indentation of the first
762 line.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000763 When 'smartindent' or 'cindent' is on the indent is changed in
764 a different way.
765 The 'autoindent' option is reset when the 'paste' option is set.
766 {small difference from Vi: After the indent is deleted when typing
767 <Esc> or <CR>, the cursor position when moving up or down is after the
768 deleted indent; Vi puts the cursor somewhere in the deleted indent}.
769
770 *'autoread'* *'ar'* *'noautoread'* *'noar'*
771'autoread' 'ar' boolean (default off)
772 global or local to buffer |global-local|
773 {not in Vi}
774 When a file has been detected to have been changed outside of Vim and
775 it has not been changed inside of Vim, automatically read it again.
776 When the file has been deleted this is not done. |timestamp|
777 If this option has a local value, use this command to switch back to
778 using the global value: >
779 :set autoread<
780<
781 *'autowrite'* *'aw'* *'noautowrite'* *'noaw'*
782'autowrite' 'aw' boolean (default off)
783 global
784 Write the contents of the file, if it has been modified, on each
785 :next, :rewind, :last, :first, :previous, :stop, :suspend, :tag, :!,
Bram Moolenaar14716812006-05-04 21:54:08 +0000786 :make, CTRL-] and CTRL-^ command; and when a :buffer, CTRL-O, CTRL-I,
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000787 '{A-Z0-9}, or `{A-Z0-9} command takes one to another file.
788 Note that for some commands the 'autowrite' option is not used, see
789 'autowriteall' for that.
790
791 *'autowriteall'* *'awa'* *'noautowriteall'* *'noawa'*
792'autowriteall' 'awa' boolean (default off)
793 global
794 {not in Vi}
795 Like 'autowrite', but also used for commands ":edit", ":enew", ":quit",
796 ":qall", ":exit", ":xit", ":recover" and closing the Vim window.
797 Setting this option also implies that Vim behaves like 'autowrite' has
798 been set.
799
800 *'background'* *'bg'*
801'background' 'bg' string (default "dark" or "light")
802 global
803 {not in Vi}
804 When set to "dark", Vim will try to use colors that look good on a
805 dark background. When set to "light", Vim will try to use colors that
806 look good on a light background. Any other value is illegal.
807 Vim tries to set the default value according to the terminal used.
808 This will not always be correct.
809 Setting this option does not change the background color, it tells Vim
810 what the background color looks like. For changing the background
811 color, see |:hi-normal|.
812
813 When 'background' is set Vim will adjust the default color groups for
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000814 the new value. But the colors used for syntax highlighting will not
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +0000815 change. *g:colors_name*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000816 When a color scheme is loaded (the "colors_name" variable is set)
817 setting 'background' will cause the color scheme to be reloaded. If
818 the color scheme adjusts to the value of 'background' this will work.
819 However, if the color scheme sets 'background' itself the effect may
820 be undone. First delete the "colors_name" variable when needed.
821
822 When setting 'background' to the default value with: >
823 :set background&
824< Vim will guess the value. In the GUI this should work correctly,
825 in other cases Vim might not be able to guess the right value.
826
827 When starting the GUI, the default value for 'background' will be
828 "light". When the value is not set in the .gvimrc, and Vim detects
829 that the background is actually quite dark, 'background' is set to
830 "dark". But this happens only AFTER the .gvimrc file has been read
831 (because the window needs to be opened to find the actual background
832 color). To get around this, force the GUI window to be opened by
833 putting a ":gui" command in the .gvimrc file, before where the value
834 of 'background' is used (e.g., before ":syntax on").
835 Normally this option would be set in the .vimrc file. Possibly
836 depending on the terminal name. Example: >
837 :if &term == "pcterm"
838 : set background=dark
839 :endif
840< When this option is set, the default settings for the highlight groups
841 will change. To use other settings, place ":highlight" commands AFTER
842 the setting of the 'background' option.
843 This option is also used in the "$VIMRUNTIME/syntax/syntax.vim" file
844 to select the colors for syntax highlighting. After changing this
845 option, you must load syntax.vim again to see the result. This can be
846 done with ":syntax on".
847
848 *'backspace'* *'bs'*
849'backspace' 'bs' string (default "")
850 global
851 {not in Vi}
852 Influences the working of <BS>, <Del>, CTRL-W and CTRL-U in Insert
853 mode. This is a list of items, separated by commas. Each item allows
854 a way to backspace over something:
855 value effect ~
856 indent allow backspacing over autoindent
857 eol allow backspacing over line breaks (join lines)
858 start allow backspacing over the start of insert; CTRL-W and CTRL-U
859 stop once at the start of insert.
860
861 When the value is empty, Vi compatible backspacing is used.
862
863 For backwards compatibility with version 5.4 and earlier:
864 value effect ~
865 0 same as ":set backspace=" (Vi compatible)
866 1 same as ":set backspace=indent,eol"
867 2 same as ":set backspace=indent,eol,start"
868
869 See |:fixdel| if your <BS> or <Del> key does not do what you want.
870 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set.
871
872 *'backup'* *'bk'* *'nobackup'* *'nobk'*
873'backup' 'bk' boolean (default off)
874 global
875 {not in Vi}
876 Make a backup before overwriting a file. Leave it around after the
877 file has been successfully written. If you do not want to keep the
878 backup file, but you do want a backup while the file is being
879 written, reset this option and set the 'writebackup' option (this is
880 the default). If you do not want a backup file at all reset both
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000881 options (use this if your file system is almost full). See the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000882 |backup-table| for more explanations.
883 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a backup is not made anyway.
884 When 'patchmode' is set, the backup may be renamed to become the
885 oldest version of a file.
886 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
887
888 *'backupcopy'* *'bkc'*
889'backupcopy' 'bkc' string (Vi default for Unix: "yes", otherwise: "auto")
890 global
891 {not in Vi}
892 When writing a file and a backup is made, this option tells how it's
893 done. This is a comma separated list of words.
894
895 The main values are:
896 "yes" make a copy of the file and overwrite the original one
897 "no" rename the file and write a new one
898 "auto" one of the previous, what works best
899
900 Extra values that can be combined with the ones above are:
901 "breaksymlink" always break symlinks when writing
902 "breakhardlink" always break hardlinks when writing
903
904 Making a copy and overwriting the original file:
905 - Takes extra time to copy the file.
906 + When the file has special attributes, is a (hard/symbolic) link or
907 has a resource fork, all this is preserved.
908 - When the file is a link the backup will have the name of the link,
909 not of the real file.
910
911 Renaming the file and writing a new one:
912 + It's fast.
913 - Sometimes not all attributes of the file can be copied to the new
914 file.
915 - When the file is a link the new file will not be a link.
916
917 The "auto" value is the middle way: When Vim sees that renaming file
918 is possible without side effects (the attributes can be passed on and
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +0000919 the file is not a link) that is used. When problems are expected, a
920 copy will be made.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000921
922 The "breaksymlink" and "breakhardlink" values can be used in
923 combination with any of "yes", "no" and "auto". When included, they
924 force Vim to always break either symbolic or hard links by doing
925 exactly what the "no" option does, renaming the original file to
926 become the backup and writing a new file in its place. This can be
927 useful for example in source trees where all the files are symbolic or
928 hard links and any changes should stay in the local source tree, not
929 be propagated back to the original source.
930 *crontab*
931 One situation where "no" and "auto" will cause problems: A program
932 that opens a file, invokes Vim to edit that file, and then tests if
933 the open file was changed (through the file descriptor) will check the
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000934 backup file instead of the newly created file. "crontab -e" is an
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000935 example.
936
937 When a copy is made, the original file is truncated and then filled
938 with the new text. This means that protection bits, owner and
939 symbolic links of the original file are unmodified. The backup file
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000940 however, is a new file, owned by the user who edited the file. The
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000941 group of the backup is set to the group of the original file. If this
942 fails, the protection bits for the group are made the same as for
943 others.
944
945 When the file is renamed this is the other way around: The backup has
946 the same attributes of the original file, and the newly written file
947 is owned by the current user. When the file was a (hard/symbolic)
948 link, the new file will not! That's why the "auto" value doesn't
949 rename when the file is a link. The owner and group of the newly
950 written file will be set to the same ones as the original file, but
951 the system may refuse to do this. In that case the "auto" value will
952 again not rename the file.
953
954 *'backupdir'* *'bdir'*
955'backupdir' 'bdir' string (default for Amiga: ".,t:",
956 for MS-DOS and Win32: ".,c:/tmp,c:/temp"
957 for Unix: ".,~/tmp,~/")
958 global
959 {not in Vi}
960 List of directories for the backup file, separated with commas.
961 - The backup file will be created in the first directory in the list
962 where this is possible.
963 - Empty means that no backup file will be created ('patchmode' is
964 impossible!). Writing may fail because of this.
965 - A directory "." means to put the backup file in the same directory
966 as the edited file.
Bram Moolenaar009b2592004-10-24 19:18:58 +0000967 - A directory starting with "./" (or ".\" for MS-DOS et al.) means to
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000968 put the backup file relative to where the edited file is. The
969 leading "." is replaced with the path name of the edited file.
970 ("." inside a directory name has no special meaning).
971 - Spaces after the comma are ignored, other spaces are considered part
972 of the directory name. To have a space at the start of a directory
973 name, precede it with a backslash.
974 - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with a backslash.
975 - A directory name may end in an '/'.
976 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
977 - Careful with '\' characters, type one before a space, type two to
978 get one in the option (see |option-backslash|), for example: >
979 :set bdir=c:\\tmp,\ dir\\,with\\,commas,\\\ dir\ with\ spaces
980< - For backwards compatibility with Vim version 3.0 a '>' at the start
981 of the option is removed.
982 See also 'backup' and 'writebackup' options.
983 If you want to hide your backup files on Unix, consider this value: >
984 :set backupdir=./.backup,~/.backup,.,/tmp
985< You must create a ".backup" directory in each directory and in your
986 home directory for this to work properly.
987 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
988 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
989 uses another default.
990 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
991 security reasons.
992
993 *'backupext'* *'bex'* *E589*
994'backupext' 'bex' string (default "~", for VMS: "_")
995 global
996 {not in Vi}
997 String which is appended to a file name to make the name of the
998 backup file. The default is quite unusual, because this avoids
999 accidentally overwriting existing files with a backup file. You might
1000 prefer using ".bak", but make sure that you don't have files with
1001 ".bak" that you want to keep.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00001002 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001003
Bram Moolenaar3fdfa4a2004-10-07 21:02:47 +00001004 If you like to keep a lot of backups, you could use a BufWritePre
1005 autocommand to change 'backupext' just before writing the file to
1006 include a timestamp. >
1007 :au BufWritePre * let &bex = '-' . strftime("%Y%b%d%X") . '~'
1008< Use 'backupdir' to put the backup in a different directory.
1009
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001010 *'backupskip'* *'bsk'*
1011'backupskip' 'bsk' string (default: "/tmp/*,$TMPDIR/*,$TMP/*,$TEMP/*")
1012 global
1013 {not in Vi}
1014 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore|
1015 feature}
1016 A list of file patterns. When one of the patterns matches with the
1017 name of the file which is written, no backup file is created. Both
1018 the specified file name and the full path name of the file are used.
1019 The pattern is used like with |:autocmd|, see |autocmd-patterns|.
1020 Watch out for special characters, see |option-backslash|.
1021 When $TMPDIR, $TMP or $TEMP is not defined, it is not used for the
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00001022 default value. "/tmp/*" is only used for Unix.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00001023
1024 Note that environment variables are not expanded. If you want to use
1025 $HOME you must expand it explicitly, e.g.: >
1026 :let backupskip = escape(expand('$HOME'), '\') . '/tmp/*'
1027
1028< Note that the default also makes sure that "crontab -e" works (when a
Bram Moolenaara5792f52005-11-23 21:25:05 +00001029 backup would be made by renaming the original file crontab won't see
1030 the newly created file). Also see 'backupcopy' and |crontab|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001031
1032 *'balloondelay'* *'bdlay'*
1033'balloondelay' 'bdlay' number (default: 600)
1034 global
1035 {not in Vi}
1036 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval|
1037 feature}
1038 Delay in milliseconds before a balloon may pop up. See |balloon-eval|.
1039
1040 *'ballooneval'* *'beval'* *'noballooneval'* *'nobeval'*
1041'ballooneval' 'beval' boolean (default off)
1042 global
1043 {not in Vi}
1044 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval|
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001045 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001046 Switch on the |balloon-eval| functionality.
1047
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001048 *'balloonexpr'* *'bexpr'*
1049'balloonexpr' 'bexpr' string (default "")
Bram Moolenaar9b2200a2006-03-20 21:55:45 +00001050 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001051 {not in Vi}
1052 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval|
1053 feature}
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00001054 Expression for text to show in evaluation balloon. It is only used
1055 when 'ballooneval' is on. These variables can be used:
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001056
1057 v:beval_bufnr number of the buffer in which balloon is going to show
1058 v:beval_winnr number of the window
1059 v:beval_lnum line number
1060 v:beval_col column number (byte index)
1061 v:beval_text word under or after the mouse pointer
1062
1063 The evaluation of the expression must not have side effects!
1064 Example: >
1065 function! MyBalloonExpr()
Bram Moolenaar45360022005-07-21 21:08:21 +00001066 return 'Cursor is at line ' . v:beval_lnum .
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001067 \', column ' . v:beval_col .
1068 \ ' of file ' . bufname(v:beval_bufnr) .
1069 \ ' on word "' . v:beval_text . '"'
1070 endfunction
1071 set bexpr=MyBalloonExpr()
1072 set ballooneval
1073<
1074 NOTE: The balloon is displayed only if the cursor is on a text
1075 character. If the result of evaluating 'balloonexpr' is not empty,
1076 Vim does not try to send a message to an external debugger (Netbeans
1077 or Sun Workshop).
1078
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00001079 The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
1080 |sandbox-option|.
1081
1082 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
1083 evaluating 'balloonexpr' |textlock|.
1084
Bram Moolenaar87e25fd2005-07-27 21:13:01 +00001085 To check whether line breaks in the balloon text work use this check: >
Bram Moolenaar45360022005-07-21 21:08:21 +00001086 if has("balloon_multiline")
Bram Moolenaar362e1a32006-03-06 23:29:24 +00001087< When they are supported "\n" characters will start a new line. If the
1088 expression evaluates to a |List| this is equal to using each List item
1089 as a string and putting "\n" in between them.
1090
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001091 *'binary'* *'bin'* *'nobinary'* *'nobin'*
1092'binary' 'bin' boolean (default off)
1093 local to buffer
1094 {not in Vi}
1095 This option should be set before editing a binary file. You can also
1096 use the |-b| Vim argument. When this option is switched on a few
1097 options will be changed (also when it already was on):
1098 'textwidth' will be set to 0
1099 'wrapmargin' will be set to 0
1100 'modeline' will be off
1101 'expandtab' will be off
1102 Also, 'fileformat' and 'fileformats' options will not be used, the
1103 file is read and written like 'fileformat' was "unix" (a single <NL>
1104 separates lines).
1105 The 'fileencoding' and 'fileencodings' options will not be used, the
1106 file is read without conversion.
1107 NOTE: When you start editing a(nother) file while the 'bin' option is
1108 on, settings from autocommands may change the settings again (e.g.,
1109 'textwidth'), causing trouble when editing. You might want to set
1110 'bin' again when the file has been loaded.
1111 The previous values of these options are remembered and restored when
1112 'bin' is switched from on to off. Each buffer has its own set of
1113 saved option values.
1114 To edit a file with 'binary' set you can use the |++bin| argument.
1115 This avoids you have to do ":set bin", which would have effect for all
1116 files you edit.
1117 When writing a file the <EOL> for the last line is only written if
1118 there was one in the original file (normally Vim appends an <EOL> to
1119 the last line if there is none; this would make the file longer). See
1120 the 'endofline' option.
1121
1122 *'bioskey'* *'biosk'* *'nobioskey'* *'nobiosk'*
1123'bioskey' 'biosk' boolean (default on)
1124 global
1125 {not in Vi} {only for MS-DOS}
Bram Moolenaar87e25fd2005-07-27 21:13:01 +00001126 When on the BIOS is called to obtain a keyboard character. This works
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001127 better to detect CTRL-C, but only works for the console. When using a
1128 terminal over a serial port reset this option.
1129 Also see |'conskey'|.
1130
1131 *'bomb'* *'nobomb'*
1132'bomb' boolean (default off)
1133 local to buffer
1134 {not in Vi}
1135 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
1136 feature}
1137 When writing a file and the following conditions are met, a BOM (Byte
1138 Order Mark) is prepended to the file:
1139 - this option is on
1140 - the 'binary' option is off
1141 - 'fileencoding' is "utf-8", "ucs-2", "ucs-4" or one of the little/big
1142 endian variants.
1143 Some applications use the BOM to recognize the encoding of the file.
1144 Often used for UCS-2 files on MS-Windows. For other applications it
1145 causes trouble, for example: "cat file1 file2" makes the BOM of file2
1146 appear halfway the resulting file.
1147 When Vim reads a file and 'fileencodings' starts with "ucs-bom", a
1148 check for the presence of the BOM is done and 'bomb' set accordingly.
1149 Unless 'binary' is set, it is removed from the first line, so that you
1150 don't see it when editing. When you don't change the options, the BOM
1151 will be restored when writing the file.
1152
1153 *'breakat'* *'brk'*
1154'breakat' 'brk' string (default " ^I!@*-+;:,./?")
1155 global
1156 {not in Vi}
1157 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
1158 feature}
1159 This option lets you choose which characters might cause a line
Bram Moolenaarac6e65f2005-08-29 22:25:38 +00001160 break if 'linebreak' is on. Only works for ASCII and also for 8-bit
1161 characters when 'encoding' is an 8-bit encoding.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001162
1163 *'browsedir'* *'bsdir'*
Bram Moolenaar7b0294c2004-10-11 10:16:09 +00001164'browsedir' 'bsdir' string (default: "last")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001165 global
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00001166 {not in Vi} {only for Motif, Athena, GTK, Mac and
1167 Win32 GUI}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001168 Which directory to use for the file browser:
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00001169 last Use same directory as with last file browser, where a
1170 file was opened or saved.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001171 buffer Use the directory of the related buffer.
1172 current Use the current directory.
1173 {path} Use the specified directory
1174
1175 *'bufhidden'* *'bh'*
1176'bufhidden' 'bh' string (default: "")
1177 local to buffer
1178 {not in Vi}
1179 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
1180 feature}
1181 This option specifies what happens when a buffer is no longer
1182 displayed in a window:
1183 <empty> follow the global 'hidden' option
1184 hide hide the buffer (don't unload it), also when 'hidden'
1185 is not set
1186 unload unload the buffer, also when 'hidden' is set or using
1187 |:hide|
1188 delete delete the buffer from the buffer list, also when
1189 'hidden' is set or using |:hide|, like using
1190 |:bdelete|
1191 wipe wipe out the buffer from the buffer list, also when
1192 'hidden' is set or using |:hide|, like using
1193 |:bwipeout|
1194
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00001195 CAREFUL: when "unload", "delete" or "wipe" is used changes in a buffer
1196 are lost without a warning.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001197 This option is used together with 'buftype' and 'swapfile' to specify
1198 special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|.
1199
1200 *'buflisted'* *'bl'* *'nobuflisted'* *'nobl'* *E85*
1201'buflisted' 'bl' boolean (default: on)
1202 local to buffer
1203 {not in Vi}
1204 When this option is set, the buffer shows up in the buffer list. If
1205 it is reset it is not used for ":bnext", "ls", the Buffers menu, etc.
1206 This option is reset by Vim for buffers that are only used to remember
1207 a file name or marks. Vim sets it when starting to edit a buffer.
1208 But not when moving to a buffer with ":buffer".
1209
1210 *'buftype'* *'bt'* *E382*
1211'buftype' 'bt' string (default: "")
1212 local to buffer
1213 {not in Vi}
1214 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
1215 feature}
1216 The value of this option specifies the type of a buffer:
1217 <empty> normal buffer
1218 nofile buffer which is not related to a file and will not be
1219 written
1220 nowrite buffer which will not be written
Bram Moolenaar21cf8232004-07-16 20:18:37 +00001221 acwrite buffer which will always be written with BufWriteCmd
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00001222 autocommands. {not available when compiled without the
Bram Moolenaar21cf8232004-07-16 20:18:37 +00001223 |+autocmd| feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001224 quickfix quickfix buffer, contains list of errors |:cwindow|
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00001225 or list of locations |:lwindow|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001226 help help buffer (you are not supposed to set this
1227 manually)
1228
1229 This option is used together with 'bufhidden' and 'swapfile' to
1230 specify special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|.
1231
1232 Be careful with changing this option, it can have many side effects!
1233
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00001234 A "quickfix" buffer is only used for the error list and the location
1235 list. This value is set by the |:cwindow| and |:lwindow| commands and
1236 you are not supposed to change it.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001237
1238 "nofile" and "nowrite" buffers are similar:
1239 both: The buffer is not to be written to disk, ":w" doesn't
1240 work (":w filename" does work though).
1241 both: The buffer is never considered to be |'modified'|.
1242 There is no warning when the changes will be lost, for
1243 example when you quit Vim.
1244 both: A swap file is only created when using too much memory
1245 (when 'swapfile' has been reset there is never a swap
1246 file).
1247 nofile only: The buffer name is fixed, it is not handled like a
1248 file name. It is not modified in response to a |:cd|
1249 command.
Bram Moolenaar21cf8232004-07-16 20:18:37 +00001250 *E676*
1251 "acwrite" implies that the buffer name is not related to a file, like
1252 "nofile", but it will be written. Thus, in contrast to "nofile" and
1253 "nowrite", ":w" does work and a modified buffer can't be abandoned
1254 without saving. For writing there must be matching |BufWriteCmd|,
1255 |FileWriteCmd| or |FileAppendCmd| autocommands.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001256
1257 *'casemap'* *'cmp'*
1258'casemap' 'cmp' string (default: "internal,keepascii")
1259 global
1260 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar2217cae2006-03-25 21:55:52 +00001261 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
1262 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001263 Specifies details about changing the case of letters. It may contain
1264 these words, separated by a comma:
1265 internal Use internal case mapping functions, the current
1266 locale does not change the case mapping. This only
Bram Moolenaar6f16eb82005-08-23 21:02:42 +00001267 matters when 'encoding' is a Unicode encoding,
1268 "latin1" or "iso-8859-15". When "internal" is
1269 omitted, the towupper() and towlower() system library
1270 functions are used when available.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001271 keepascii For the ASCII characters (0x00 to 0x7f) use the US
1272 case mapping, the current locale is not effective.
1273 This probably only matters for Turkish.
1274
1275 *'cdpath'* *'cd'* *E344* *E346*
1276'cdpath' 'cd' string (default: equivalent to $CDPATH or ",,")
1277 global
1278 {not in Vi}
1279 {not available when compiled without the
1280 |+file_in_path| feature}
1281 This is a list of directories which will be searched when using the
1282 |:cd| and |:lcd| commands, provided that the directory being searched
Bram Moolenaarc236c162008-07-13 17:41:49 +00001283 for has a relative path, not an absolute part starting with "/", "./"
1284 or "../", the 'cdpath' option is not used then.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001285 The 'cdpath' option's value has the same form and semantics as
1286 |'path'|. Also see |file-searching|.
1287 The default value is taken from $CDPATH, with a "," prepended to look
1288 in the current directory first.
1289 If the default value taken from $CDPATH is not what you want, include
1290 a modified version of the following command in your vimrc file to
1291 override it: >
1292 :let &cdpath = ',' . substitute(substitute($CDPATH, '[, ]', '\\\0', 'g'), ':', ',', 'g')
1293< This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
1294 security reasons.
1295 (parts of 'cdpath' can be passed to the shell to expand file names).
1296
1297 *'cedit'*
1298'cedit' string (Vi default: "", Vim default: CTRL-F)
1299 global
1300 {not in Vi}
1301 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit|
1302 feature}
1303 The key used in Command-line Mode to open the command-line window.
1304 The default is CTRL-F when 'compatible' is off.
1305 Only non-printable keys are allowed.
1306 The key can be specified as a single character, but it is difficult to
1307 type. The preferred way is to use the <> notation. Examples: >
1308 :set cedit=<C-Y>
1309 :set cedit=<Esc>
1310< |Nvi| also has this option, but it only uses the first character.
1311 See |cmdwin|.
1312
1313 *'charconvert'* *'ccv'* *E202* *E214* *E513*
1314'charconvert' 'ccv' string (default "")
1315 global
1316 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
1317 feature and the |+eval| feature}
1318 {not in Vi}
1319 An expression that is used for character encoding conversion. It is
1320 evaluated when a file that is to be read or has been written has a
1321 different encoding from what is desired.
1322 'charconvert' is not used when the internal iconv() function is
1323 supported and is able to do the conversion. Using iconv() is
1324 preferred, because it is much faster.
1325 'charconvert' is not used when reading stdin |--|, because there is no
1326 file to convert from. You will have to save the text in a file first.
1327 The expression must return zero or an empty string for success,
1328 non-zero for failure.
1329 The possible encoding names encountered are in 'encoding'.
1330 Additionally, names given in 'fileencodings' and 'fileencoding' are
1331 used.
1332 Conversion between "latin1", "unicode", "ucs-2", "ucs-4" and "utf-8"
1333 is done internally by Vim, 'charconvert' is not used for this.
1334 'charconvert' is also used to convert the viminfo file, if the 'c'
1335 flag is present in 'viminfo'. Also used for Unicode conversion.
1336 Example: >
1337 set charconvert=CharConvert()
1338 fun CharConvert()
1339 system("recode "
1340 \ . v:charconvert_from . ".." . v:charconvert_to
1341 \ . " <" . v:fname_in . " >" v:fname_out)
1342 return v:shell_error
1343 endfun
1344< The related Vim variables are:
1345 v:charconvert_from name of the current encoding
1346 v:charconvert_to name of the desired encoding
1347 v:fname_in name of the input file
1348 v:fname_out name of the output file
1349 Note that v:fname_in and v:fname_out will never be the same.
1350 Note that v:charconvert_from and v:charconvert_to may be different
1351 from 'encoding'. Vim internally uses UTF-8 instead of UCS-2 or UCS-4.
1352 Encryption is not done by Vim when using 'charconvert'. If you want
1353 to encrypt the file after conversion, 'charconvert' should take care
1354 of this.
1355 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
1356 security reasons.
1357
1358 *'cindent'* *'cin'* *'nocindent'* *'nocin'*
1359'cindent' 'cin' boolean (default off)
1360 local to buffer
1361 {not in Vi}
1362 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
1363 feature}
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00001364 Enables automatic C program indenting. See 'cinkeys' to set the keys
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001365 that trigger reindenting in insert mode and 'cinoptions' to set your
1366 preferred indent style.
1367 If 'indentexpr' is not empty, it overrules 'cindent'.
1368 If 'lisp' is not on and both 'indentexpr' and 'equalprg' are empty,
1369 the "=" operator indents using this algorithm rather than calling an
1370 external program.
1371 See |C-indenting|.
1372 When you don't like the way 'cindent' works, try the 'smartindent'
1373 option or 'indentexpr'.
1374 This option is not used when 'paste' is set.
1375 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
1376
1377 *'cinkeys'* *'cink'*
1378'cinkeys' 'cink' string (default "0{,0},0),:,0#,!^F,o,O,e")
1379 local to buffer
1380 {not in Vi}
1381 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
1382 feature}
1383 A list of keys that, when typed in Insert mode, cause reindenting of
1384 the current line. Only used if 'cindent' is on and 'indentexpr' is
1385 empty.
1386 For the format of this option see |cinkeys-format|.
1387 See |C-indenting|.
1388
1389 *'cinoptions'* *'cino'*
1390'cinoptions' 'cino' string (default "")
1391 local to buffer
1392 {not in Vi}
1393 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
1394 feature}
1395 The 'cinoptions' affect the way 'cindent' reindents lines in a C
1396 program. See |cinoptions-values| for the values of this option, and
1397 |C-indenting| for info on C indenting in general.
1398
1399
1400 *'cinwords'* *'cinw'*
1401'cinwords' 'cinw' string (default "if,else,while,do,for,switch")
1402 local to buffer
1403 {not in Vi}
1404 {not available when compiled without both the
1405 |+cindent| and the |+smartindent| features}
1406 These keywords start an extra indent in the next line when
1407 'smartindent' or 'cindent' is set. For 'cindent' this is only done at
1408 an appropriate place (inside {}).
1409 Note that 'ignorecase' isn't used for 'cinwords'. If case doesn't
1410 matter, include the keyword both the uppercase and lowercase:
1411 "if,If,IF".
1412
1413 *'clipboard'* *'cb'*
1414'clipboard' 'cb' string (default "autoselect,exclude:cons\|linux"
1415 for X-windows, "" otherwise)
1416 global
1417 {not in Vi}
1418 {only in GUI versions or when the |+xterm_clipboard|
1419 feature is included}
1420 This option is a list of comma separated names.
1421 These names are recognized:
1422
1423 unnamed When included, Vim will use the clipboard register '*'
1424 for all yank, delete, change and put operations which
1425 would normally go to the unnamed register. When a
1426 register is explicitly specified, it will always be
1427 used regardless of whether "unnamed" is in 'clipboard'
1428 or not. The clipboard register can always be
1429 explicitly accessed using the "* notation. Also see
1430 |gui-clipboard|.
1431
1432 autoselect Works like the 'a' flag in 'guioptions': If present,
1433 then whenever Visual mode is started, or the Visual
1434 area extended, Vim tries to become the owner of the
1435 windowing system's global selection or put the
1436 selected text on the clipboard used by the selection
1437 register "*. See |guioptions_a| and |quotestar| for
1438 details. When the GUI is active, the 'a' flag in
1439 'guioptions' is used, when the GUI is not active, this
1440 "autoselect" flag is used.
1441 Also applies to the modeless selection.
1442
1443 autoselectml Like "autoselect", but for the modeless selection
1444 only. Compare to the 'A' flag in 'guioptions'.
1445
Bram Moolenaar3a6eaa52009-06-16 13:23:06 +00001446 html When the clipboard contains HTML, use this when
1447 pasting. When putting text on the clipboard, mark it
1448 as HTML. This works to copy rendered HTML from
1449 Firefox, paste it as raw HTML in Vim, select the HTML
1450 in Vim and paste it in a rich edit box in Firefox.
1451 Only supported for GTK version 2 and later.
1452 Only available with the |+multi_byte| feature.
1453
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001454 exclude:{pattern}
1455 Defines a pattern that is matched against the name of
1456 the terminal 'term'. If there is a match, no
1457 connection will be made to the X server. This is
1458 useful in this situation:
1459 - Running Vim in a console.
1460 - $DISPLAY is set to start applications on another
1461 display.
1462 - You do not want to connect to the X server in the
1463 console, but do want this in a terminal emulator.
1464 To never connect to the X server use: >
1465 exclude:.*
1466< This has the same effect as using the |-X| argument.
1467 Note that when there is no connection to the X server
1468 the window title won't be restored and the clipboard
1469 cannot be accessed.
1470 The value of 'magic' is ignored, {pattern} is
1471 interpreted as if 'magic' was on.
1472 The rest of the option value will be used for
1473 {pattern}, this must be the last entry.
1474
1475 *'cmdheight'* *'ch'*
1476'cmdheight' 'ch' number (default 1)
1477 global
1478 {not in Vi}
1479 Number of screen lines to use for the command-line. Helps avoiding
1480 |hit-enter| prompts.
Bram Moolenaarc6fe9192006-04-09 21:54:49 +00001481 The value of this option is stored with the tab page, so that each tab
1482 page can have a different value.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001483
1484 *'cmdwinheight'* *'cwh'*
1485'cmdwinheight' 'cwh' number (default 7)
1486 global
1487 {not in Vi}
1488 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit|
1489 feature}
1490 Number of screen lines to use for the command-line window. |cmdwin|
1491
1492 *'columns'* *'co'* *E594*
1493'columns' 'co' number (default 80 or terminal width)
1494 global
1495 {not in Vi}
1496 Number of columns of the screen. Normally this is set by the terminal
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00001497 initialization and does not have to be set by hand. Also see
1498 |posix-screen-size|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001499 When Vim is running in the GUI or in a resizable window, setting this
1500 option will cause the window size to be changed. When you only want
1501 to use the size for the GUI, put the command in your |gvimrc| file.
1502 When you set this option and Vim is unable to change the physical
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00001503 number of columns of the display, the display may be messed up. For
1504 the GUI it is always possible and Vim limits the number of columns to
1505 what fits on the screen. You can use this command to get the widest
1506 window possible: >
1507 :set columns=9999
1508< Minimum value is 12, maximum value is 10000.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001509
1510 *'comments'* *'com'* *E524* *E525*
1511'comments' 'com' string (default
1512 "s1:/*,mb:*,ex:*/,://,b:#,:%,:XCOMM,n:>,fb:-")
1513 local to buffer
1514 {not in Vi}
1515 {not available when compiled without the |+comments|
1516 feature}
1517 A comma separated list of strings that can start a comment line. See
1518 |format-comments|. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes to
1519 insert a space.
1520
1521 *'commentstring'* *'cms'* *E537*
1522'commentstring' 'cms' string (default "/*%s*/")
1523 local to buffer
1524 {not in Vi}
1525 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
1526 feature}
1527 A template for a comment. The "%s" in the value is replaced with the
1528 comment text. Currently only used to add markers for folding, see
1529 |fold-marker|.
1530
1531 *'compatible'* *'cp'* *'nocompatible'* *'nocp'*
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00001532'compatible' 'cp' boolean (default on, off when a |vimrc| or |gvimrc|
1533 file is found)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001534 global
1535 {not in Vi}
1536 This option has the effect of making Vim either more Vi-compatible, or
1537 make Vim behave in a more useful way.
1538 This is a special kind of option, because when it's set or reset,
1539 other options are also changed as a side effect. CAREFUL: Setting or
1540 resetting this option can have a lot of unexpected effects: Mappings
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00001541 are interpreted in another way, undo behaves differently, etc. If you
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001542 set this option in your vimrc file, you should probably put it at the
1543 very start.
1544 By default this option is on and the Vi defaults are used for the
1545 options. This default was chosen for those people who want to use Vim
1546 just like Vi, and don't even (want to) know about the 'compatible'
1547 option.
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00001548 When a |vimrc| or |gvimrc| file is found while Vim is starting up,
Bram Moolenaard042c562005-06-30 22:04:15 +00001549 this option is switched off, and all options that have not been
1550 modified will be set to the Vim defaults. Effectively, this means
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00001551 that when a |vimrc| or |gvimrc| file exists, Vim will use the Vim
Bram Moolenaard042c562005-06-30 22:04:15 +00001552 defaults, otherwise it will use the Vi defaults. (Note: This doesn't
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00001553 happen for the system-wide vimrc or gvimrc file, nor for a file given
1554 with the |-u| argument). Also see |compatible-default| and
1555 |posix-compliance|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001556 You can also set this option with the "-C" argument, and reset it with
1557 "-N". See |-C| and |-N|.
1558 Switching this option off makes the Vim defaults be used for options
1559 that have a different Vi and Vim default value. See the options
1560 marked with a '+' below. Other options are not modified.
1561 At the moment this option is set, several other options will be set
1562 or reset to make Vim as Vi-compatible as possible. See the table
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00001563 below. This can be used if you want to revert to Vi compatible
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001564 editing.
1565 See also 'cpoptions'.
1566
1567 option + set value effect ~
1568
1569 'allowrevins' off no CTRL-_ command
1570 'backupcopy' Unix: "yes" backup file is a copy
1571 others: "auto" copy or rename backup file
1572 'backspace' "" normal backspace
1573 'backup' off no backup file
1574 'cindent' off no C code indentation
1575 'cedit' + "" no key to open the |cmdwin|
1576 'cpoptions' + (all flags) Vi-compatible flags
1577 'cscopetag' off don't use cscope for ":tag"
1578 'cscopetagorder' 0 see |cscopetagorder|
1579 'cscopeverbose' off see |cscopeverbose|
1580 'digraph' off no digraphs
1581 'esckeys' + off no <Esc>-keys in Insert mode
1582 'expandtab' off tabs not expanded to spaces
1583 'fileformats' + "" no automatic file format detection,
1584 "dos,unix" except for DOS, Windows and OS/2
1585 'formatoptions' + "vt" Vi compatible formatting
1586 'gdefault' off no default 'g' flag for ":s"
1587 'history' + 0 no commandline history
1588 'hkmap' off no Hebrew keyboard mapping
1589 'hkmapp' off no phonetic Hebrew keyboard mapping
1590 'hlsearch' off no highlighting of search matches
1591 'incsearch' off no incremental searching
1592 'indentexpr' "" no indenting by expression
1593 'insertmode' off do not start in Insert mode
1594 'iskeyword' + "@,48-57,_" keywords contain alphanumeric
1595 characters and '_'
1596 'joinspaces' on insert 2 spaces after period
1597 'modeline' + off no modelines
1598 'more' + off no pauses in listings
1599 'revins' off no reverse insert
1600 'ruler' off no ruler
1601 'scrolljump' 1 no jump scroll
1602 'scrolloff' 0 no scroll offset
1603 'shiftround' off indent not rounded to shiftwidth
1604 'shortmess' + "" no shortening of messages
1605 'showcmd' + off command characters not shown
1606 'showmode' + off current mode not shown
1607 'smartcase' off no automatic ignore case switch
1608 'smartindent' off no smart indentation
1609 'smarttab' off no smart tab size
1610 'softtabstop' 0 tabs are always 'tabstop' positions
1611 'startofline' on goto startofline with some commands
1612 'tagrelative' + off tag file names are not relative
1613 'textauto' + off no automatic textmode detection
1614 'textwidth' 0 no automatic line wrap
1615 'tildeop' off tilde is not an operator
1616 'ttimeout' off no terminal timeout
1617 'whichwrap' + "" left-right movements don't wrap
1618 'wildchar' + CTRL-E only when the current value is <Tab>
1619 use CTRL-E for cmdline completion
1620 'writebackup' on or off depends on +writebackup feature
1621
1622 *'complete'* *'cpt'* *E535*
1623'complete' 'cpt' string (default: ".,w,b,u,t,i")
1624 local to buffer
1625 {not in Vi}
1626 This option specifies how keyword completion |ins-completion| works
1627 when CTRL-P or CTRL-N are used. It is also used for whole-line
1628 completion |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-L|. It indicates the type of completion
1629 and the places to scan. It is a comma separated list of flags:
1630 . scan the current buffer ('wrapscan' is ignored)
1631 w scan buffers from other windows
1632 b scan other loaded buffers that are in the buffer list
1633 u scan the unloaded buffers that are in the buffer list
1634 U scan the buffers that are not in the buffer list
1635 k scan the files given with the 'dictionary' option
Bram Moolenaar0b238792006-03-02 22:49:12 +00001636 kspell use the currently active spell checking |spell|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001637 k{dict} scan the file {dict}. Several "k" flags can be given,
1638 patterns are valid too. For example: >
1639 :set cpt=k/usr/dict/*,k~/spanish
1640< s scan the files given with the 'thesaurus' option
1641 s{tsr} scan the file {tsr}. Several "s" flags can be given, patterns
1642 are valid too.
1643 i scan current and included files
1644 d scan current and included files for defined name or macro
1645 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-D|
1646 ] tag completion
1647 t same as "]"
1648
1649 Unloaded buffers are not loaded, thus their autocmds |:autocmd| are
1650 not executed, this may lead to unexpected completions from some files
1651 (gzipped files for example). Unloaded buffers are not scanned for
1652 whole-line completion.
1653
1654 The default is ".,w,b,u,t,i", which means to scan:
1655 1. the current buffer
1656 2. buffers in other windows
1657 3. other loaded buffers
1658 4. unloaded buffers
1659 5. tags
1660 6. included files
1661
1662 As you can see, CTRL-N and CTRL-P can be used to do any 'iskeyword'-
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00001663 based expansion (e.g., dictionary |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K|, included patterns
1664 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-I|, tags |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-]| and normal expansions).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001665
Bram Moolenaarcfbc5ee2004-07-02 15:38:35 +00001666 *'completefunc'* *'cfu'*
1667'completefunc' 'cfu' string (default: empty)
1668 local to buffer
1669 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar5a8684e2005-07-30 22:43:24 +00001670 {not available when compiled without the +eval
1671 or +insert_expand feature}
Bram Moolenaarc7486e02005-12-29 22:48:26 +00001672 This option specifies a function to be used for Insert mode completion
1673 with CTRL-X CTRL-U. |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-U|
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00001674 See |complete-functions| for an explanation of how the function is
1675 invoked and what it should return.
Bram Moolenaar5a8684e2005-07-30 22:43:24 +00001676
Bram Moolenaar325b7a22004-07-05 15:58:32 +00001677
Bram Moolenaar1c7715d2005-10-03 22:02:18 +00001678 *'completeopt'* *'cot'*
Bram Moolenaar96d2c5b2006-03-11 21:27:59 +00001679'completeopt' 'cot' string (default: "menu,preview")
Bram Moolenaar1c7715d2005-10-03 22:02:18 +00001680 global
Bram Moolenaar7d47b6e2006-03-15 22:59:18 +00001681 {not available when compiled without the
1682 |+insert_expand| feature}
Bram Moolenaar1c7715d2005-10-03 22:02:18 +00001683 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaarc7453f52006-02-10 23:20:28 +00001684 A comma separated list of options for Insert mode completion
1685 |ins-completion|. The supported values are:
Bram Moolenaar1c7715d2005-10-03 22:02:18 +00001686
1687 menu Use a popup menu to show the possible completions. The
1688 menu is only shown when there is more than one match and
1689 sufficient colors are available. |ins-completion-menu|
1690
Bram Moolenaar65c923a2006-03-03 22:56:30 +00001691 menuone Use the popup menu also when there is only one match.
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00001692 Useful when there is additional information about the
Bram Moolenaar65c923a2006-03-03 22:56:30 +00001693 match, e.g., what file it comes from.
1694
Bram Moolenaarc1e37902006-04-18 21:55:01 +00001695 longest Only insert the longest common text of the matches. If
1696 the menu is displayed you can use CTRL-L to add more
1697 characters. Whether case is ignored depends on the kind
1698 of completion. For buffer text the 'ignorecase' option is
1699 used.
Bram Moolenaarc7453f52006-02-10 23:20:28 +00001700
Bram Moolenaar96d2c5b2006-03-11 21:27:59 +00001701 preview Show extra information about the currently selected
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00001702 completion in the preview window. Only works in
1703 combination with "menu" or "menuone".
1704
Bram Moolenaar96d2c5b2006-03-11 21:27:59 +00001705
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001706 *'confirm'* *'cf'* *'noconfirm'* *'nocf'*
1707'confirm' 'cf' boolean (default off)
1708 global
1709 {not in Vi}
1710 When 'confirm' is on, certain operations that would normally
1711 fail because of unsaved changes to a buffer, e.g. ":q" and ":e",
1712 instead raise a |dialog| asking if you wish to save the current
1713 file(s). You can still use a ! to unconditionally |abandon| a buffer.
1714 If 'confirm' is off you can still activate confirmation for one
1715 command only (this is most useful in mappings) with the |:confirm|
1716 command.
1717 Also see the |confirm()| function and the 'v' flag in 'guioptions'.
1718
1719 *'conskey'* *'consk'* *'noconskey'* *'noconsk'*
1720'conskey' 'consk' boolean (default off)
1721 global
1722 {not in Vi} {only for MS-DOS}
1723 When on direct console I/O is used to obtain a keyboard character.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00001724 This should work in most cases. Also see |'bioskey'|. Together,
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001725 three methods of console input are available:
1726 'conskey' 'bioskey' action ~
1727 on on or off direct console input
1728 off on BIOS
1729 off off STDIN
1730
1731 *'copyindent'* *'ci'* *'nocopyindent'* *'noci'*
1732'copyindent' 'ci' boolean (default off)
1733 local to buffer
1734 {not in Vi}
1735 Copy the structure of the existing lines indent when autoindenting a
1736 new line. Normally the new indent is reconstructed by a series of
1737 tabs followed by spaces as required (unless |'expandtab'| is enabled,
1738 in which case only spaces are used). Enabling this option makes the
1739 new line copy whatever characters were used for indenting on the
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00001740 existing line. 'expandtab' has no effect on these characters, a Tab
1741 remains a Tab. If the new indent is greater than on the existing
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001742 line, the remaining space is filled in the normal manner.
1743 NOTE: 'copyindent' is reset when 'compatible' is set.
1744 Also see 'preserveindent'.
1745
1746 *'cpoptions'* *'cpo'*
1747'cpoptions' 'cpo' string (Vim default: "aABceFs",
1748 Vi default: all flags)
1749 global
1750 {not in Vi}
1751 A sequence of single character flags. When a character is present
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00001752 this indicates vi-compatible behavior. This is used for things where
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001753 not being vi-compatible is mostly or sometimes preferred.
1754 'cpoptions' stands for "compatible-options".
1755 Commas can be added for readability.
1756 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the
1757 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|.
1758 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
1759 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00001760 NOTE: This option is set to the POSIX default value at startup when
1761 the Vi default value would be used and the $VIM_POSIX environment
1762 variable exists |posix|. This means tries to behave like the POSIX
1763 specification.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001764
1765 contains behavior ~
1766 *cpo-a*
1767 a When included, a ":read" command with a file name
1768 argument will set the alternate file name for the
1769 current window.
1770 *cpo-A*
1771 A When included, a ":write" command with a file name
1772 argument will set the alternate file name for the
1773 current window.
1774 *cpo-b*
1775 b "\|" in a ":map" command is recognized as the end of
1776 the map command. The '\' is included in the mapping,
1777 the text after the '|' is interpreted as the next
1778 command. Use a CTRL-V instead of a backslash to
1779 include the '|' in the mapping. Applies to all
1780 mapping, abbreviation, menu and autocmd commands.
1781 See also |map_bar|.
1782 *cpo-B*
1783 B A backslash has no special meaning in mappings,
1784 abbreviations and the "to" part of the menu commands.
1785 Remove this flag to be able to use a backslash like a
1786 CTRL-V. For example, the command ":map X \<Esc>"
1787 results in X being mapped to:
1788 'B' included: "\^[" (^[ is a real <Esc>)
1789 'B' excluded: "<Esc>" (5 characters)
1790 ('<' excluded in both cases)
1791 *cpo-c*
1792 c Searching continues at the end of any match at the
1793 cursor position, but not further than the start of the
1794 next line. When not present searching continues
1795 one character from the cursor position. With 'c'
1796 "abababababab" only gets three matches when repeating
1797 "/abab", without 'c' there are five matches.
1798 *cpo-C*
1799 C Do not concatenate sourced lines that start with a
1800 backslash. See |line-continuation|.
1801 *cpo-d*
1802 d Using "./" in the 'tags' option doesn't mean to use
1803 the tags file relative to the current file, but the
1804 tags file in the current directory.
1805 *cpo-D*
1806 D Can't use CTRL-K to enter a digraph after Normal mode
1807 commands with a character argument, like |r|, |f| and
1808 |t|.
1809 *cpo-e*
1810 e When executing a register with ":@r", always add a
1811 <CR> to the last line, also when the register is not
1812 linewise. If this flag is not present, the register
1813 is not linewise and the last line does not end in a
1814 <CR>, then the last line is put on the command-line
1815 and can be edited before hitting <CR>.
1816 *cpo-E*
1817 E It is an error when using "y", "d", "c", "g~", "gu" or
1818 "gU" on an Empty region. The operators only work when
1819 at least one character is to be operate on. Example:
1820 This makes "y0" fail in the first column.
1821 *cpo-f*
1822 f When included, a ":read" command with a file name
1823 argument will set the file name for the current buffer,
1824 if the current buffer doesn't have a file name yet.
1825 *cpo-F*
1826 F When included, a ":write" command with a file name
1827 argument will set the file name for the current
1828 buffer, if the current buffer doesn't have a file name
Bram Moolenaarb3480382005-12-11 21:33:32 +00001829 yet. Also see |cpo-P|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001830 *cpo-g*
1831 g Goto line 1 when using ":edit" without argument.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00001832 *cpo-H*
1833 H When using "I" on a line with only blanks, insert
1834 before the last blank. Without this flag insert after
1835 the last blank.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001836 *cpo-i*
1837 i When included, interrupting the reading of a file will
1838 leave it modified.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00001839 *cpo-I*
1840 I When moving the cursor up or down just after inserting
1841 indent for 'autoindent', do not delete the indent.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001842 *cpo-j*
1843 j When joining lines, only add two spaces after a '.',
1844 not after '!' or '?'. Also see 'joinspaces'.
1845 *cpo-J*
1846 J A |sentence| has to be followed by two spaces after
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00001847 the '.', '!' or '?'. A <Tab> is not recognized as
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001848 white space.
1849 *cpo-k*
1850 k Disable the recognition of raw key codes in
1851 mappings, abbreviations, and the "to" part of menu
1852 commands. For example, if <Key> sends ^[OA (where ^[
1853 is <Esc>), the command ":map X ^[OA" results in X
1854 being mapped to:
1855 'k' included: "^[OA" (3 characters)
1856 'k' excluded: "<Key>" (one key code)
1857 Also see the '<' flag below.
1858 *cpo-K*
1859 K Don't wait for a key code to complete when it is
1860 halfway a mapping. This breaks mapping <F1><F1> when
1861 only part of the second <F1> has been read. It
1862 enables cancelling the mapping by typing <F1><Esc>.
1863 *cpo-l*
1864 l Backslash in a [] range in a search pattern is taken
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00001865 literally, only "\]", "\^", "\-" and "\\" are special.
1866 See |/[]|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001867 'l' included: "/[ \t]" finds <Space>, '\' and 't'
1868 'l' excluded: "/[ \t]" finds <Space> and <Tab>
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00001869 Also see |cpo-\|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001870 *cpo-L*
1871 L When the 'list' option is set, 'wrapmargin',
1872 'textwidth', 'softtabstop' and Virtual Replace mode
1873 (see |gR|) count a <Tab> as two characters, instead of
1874 the normal behavior of a <Tab>.
1875 *cpo-m*
1876 m When included, a showmatch will always wait half a
1877 second. When not included, a showmatch will wait half
1878 a second or until a character is typed. |'showmatch'|
1879 *cpo-M*
1880 M When excluded, "%" matching will take backslashes into
1881 account. Thus in "( \( )" and "\( ( \)" the outer
1882 parenthesis match. When included "%" ignores
1883 backslashes, which is Vi compatible.
1884 *cpo-n*
1885 n When included, the column used for 'number' will also
1886 be used for text of wrapped lines.
1887 *cpo-o*
1888 o Line offset to search command is not remembered for
1889 next search.
1890 *cpo-O*
1891 O Don't complain if a file is being overwritten, even
1892 when it didn't exist when editing it. This is a
1893 protection against a file unexpectedly created by
1894 someone else. Vi didn't complain about this.
1895 *cpo-p*
1896 p Vi compatible Lisp indenting. When not present, a
1897 slightly better algorithm is used.
Bram Moolenaarb3480382005-12-11 21:33:32 +00001898 *cpo-P*
1899 P When included, a ":write" command that appends to a
1900 file will set the file name for the current buffer, if
1901 the current buffer doesn't have a file name yet and
1902 the 'F' flag is also included |cpo-F|.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00001903 *cpo-q*
1904 q When joining multiple lines leave the cursor at the
1905 position where it would be when joining two lines.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001906 *cpo-r*
1907 r Redo ("." command) uses "/" to repeat a search
1908 command, instead of the actually used search string.
1909 *cpo-R*
1910 R Remove marks from filtered lines. Without this flag
1911 marks are kept like |:keepmarks| was used.
1912 *cpo-s*
1913 s Set buffer options when entering the buffer for the
1914 first time. This is like it is in Vim version 3.0.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00001915 And it is the default. If not present the options are
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001916 set when the buffer is created.
1917 *cpo-S*
1918 S Set buffer options always when entering a buffer
1919 (except 'readonly', 'fileformat', 'filetype' and
1920 'syntax'). This is the (most) Vi compatible setting.
1921 The options are set to the values in the current
1922 buffer. When you change an option and go to another
1923 buffer, the value is copied. Effectively makes the
1924 buffer options global to all buffers.
1925
1926 's' 'S' copy buffer options
1927 no no when buffer created
1928 yes no when buffer first entered (default)
1929 X yes each time when buffer entered (vi comp.)
1930 *cpo-t*
1931 t Search pattern for the tag command is remembered for
1932 "n" command. Otherwise Vim only puts the pattern in
1933 the history for search pattern, but doesn't change the
1934 last used search pattern.
1935 *cpo-u*
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00001936 u Undo is Vi compatible. See |undo-two-ways|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001937 *cpo-v*
1938 v Backspaced characters remain visible on the screen in
1939 Insert mode. Without this flag the characters are
1940 erased from the screen right away. With this flag the
1941 screen newly typed text overwrites backspaced
1942 characters.
1943 *cpo-w*
1944 w When using "cw" on a blank character, only change one
1945 character and not all blanks until the start of the
1946 next word.
1947 *cpo-W*
1948 W Don't overwrite a readonly file. When omitted, ":w!"
1949 overwrites a readonly file, if possible.
1950 *cpo-x*
1951 x <Esc> on the command-line executes the command-line.
1952 The default in Vim is to abandon the command-line,
1953 because <Esc> normally aborts a command. |c_<Esc>|
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00001954 *cpo-X*
1955 X When using a count with "R" the replaced text is
1956 deleted only once. Also when repeating "R" with "."
1957 and a count.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001958 *cpo-y*
1959 y A yank command can be redone with ".".
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00001960 *cpo-Z*
1961 Z When using "w!" while the 'readonly' option is set,
1962 don't reset 'readonly'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001963 *cpo-!*
1964 ! When redoing a filter command, use the last used
1965 external command, whatever it was. Otherwise the last
1966 used -filter- command is used.
1967 *cpo-$*
1968 $ When making a change to one line, don't redisplay the
1969 line, but put a '$' at the end of the changed text.
1970 The changed text will be overwritten when you type the
1971 new text. The line is redisplayed if you type any
1972 command that moves the cursor from the insertion
1973 point.
1974 *cpo-%*
1975 % Vi-compatible matching is done for the "%" command.
1976 Does not recognize "#if", "#endif", etc.
1977 Does not recognize "/*" and "*/".
1978 Parens inside single and double quotes are also
1979 counted, causing a string that contains a paren to
1980 disturb the matching. For example, in a line like
1981 "if (strcmp("foo(", s))" the first paren does not
1982 match the last one. When this flag is not included,
1983 parens inside single and double quotes are treated
1984 specially. When matching a paren outside of quotes,
1985 everything inside quotes is ignored. When matching a
1986 paren inside quotes, it will find the matching one (if
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00001987 there is one). This works very well for C programs.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00001988 This flag is also used for other features, such as
1989 C-indenting.
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00001990 *cpo--*
1991 - When included, a vertical movement command fails when
Bram Moolenaar8ada17c2006-01-19 22:16:24 +00001992 it would go above the first line or below the last
1993 line. Without it the cursor moves to the first or
1994 last line, unless it already was in that line.
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00001995 Applies to the commands "-", "k", CTRL-P, "+", "j",
Bram Moolenaar8ada17c2006-01-19 22:16:24 +00001996 CTRL-N, CTRL-J and ":1234".
Bram Moolenaar1cd871b2004-12-19 22:46:22 +00001997 *cpo-+*
1998 + When included, a ":write file" command will reset the
1999 'modified' flag of the buffer, even though the buffer
2000 itself may still be different from its file.
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00002001 *cpo-star*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002002 * Use ":*" in the same way as ":@". When not included,
2003 ":*" is an alias for ":'<,'>", select the Visual area.
2004 *cpo-<*
2005 < Disable the recognition of special key codes in |<>|
2006 form in mappings, abbreviations, and the "to" part of
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002007 menu commands. For example, the command
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002008 ":map X <Tab>" results in X being mapped to:
2009 '<' included: "<Tab>" (5 characters)
2010 '<' excluded: "^I" (^I is a real <Tab>)
2011 Also see the 'k' flag above.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002012 *cpo->*
2013 > When appending to a register, put a line break before
2014 the appended text.
2015
2016 POSIX flags. These are not included in the Vi default value, except
2017 when $VIM_POSIX was set on startup. |posix|
2018
2019 contains behavior ~
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00002020 *cpo-#*
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002021 # A count before "D", "o" and "O" has no effect.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002022 *cpo-&*
2023 & When ":preserve" was used keep the swap file when
2024 exiting normally while this buffer is still loaded.
2025 This flag is tested when exiting.
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00002026 *cpo-\*
2027 \ Backslash in a [] range in a search pattern is taken
2028 literally, only "\]" is special See |/[]|
Bram Moolenaar90915b52005-08-21 22:17:52 +00002029 '\' included: "/[ \-]" finds <Space>, '\' and '-'
2030 '\' excluded: "/[ \-]" finds <Space> and '-'
2031 Also see |cpo-l|.
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00002032 *cpo-/*
2033 / When "%" is used as the replacement string in a |:s|
2034 command, use the previous replacement string. |:s%|
2035 *cpo-{*
2036 { The |{| and |}| commands also stop at a "{" character
2037 at the start of a line.
2038 *cpo-.*
2039 . The ":chdir" and ":cd" commands fail if the current
2040 buffer is modified, unless ! is used. Vim doesn't
2041 need this, since it remembers the full path of an
2042 opened file.
2043 *cpo-bar*
2044 | The value of the $LINES and $COLUMNS environment
2045 variables overrule the terminal size values obtained
2046 with system specific functions.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002047
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002048
2049 *'cscopepathcomp'* *'cspc'*
2050'cscopepathcomp' 'cspc' number (default 0)
2051 global
2052 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2053 feature}
2054 {not in Vi}
2055 Determines how many components of the path to show in a list of tags.
2056 See |cscopepathcomp|.
2057
2058 *'cscopeprg'* *'csprg'*
2059'cscopeprg' 'csprg' string (default "cscope")
2060 global
2061 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2062 feature}
2063 {not in Vi}
2064 Specifies the command to execute cscope. See |cscopeprg|.
2065 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
2066 security reasons.
2067
2068 *'cscopequickfix'* *'csqf'*
2069'cscopequickfix' 'csqf' string (default "")
2070 global
2071 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2072 or |+quickfix| features}
2073 {not in Vi}
2074 Specifies whether to use quickfix window to show cscope results.
2075 See |cscopequickfix|.
2076
2077 *'cscopetag'* *'cst'* *'nocscopetag'* *'nocst'*
2078'cscopetag' 'cst' boolean (default off)
2079 global
2080 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2081 feature}
2082 {not in Vi}
2083 Use cscope for tag commands. See |cscope-options|.
2084 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
2085
2086 *'cscopetagorder'* *'csto'*
2087'cscopetagorder' 'csto' number (default 0)
2088 global
2089 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2090 feature}
2091 {not in Vi}
2092 Determines the order in which ":cstag" performs a search. See
2093 |cscopetagorder|.
2094 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
2095
2096 *'cscopeverbose'* *'csverb'*
2097 *'nocscopeverbose'* *'nocsverb'*
2098'cscopeverbose' 'csverb' boolean (default off)
2099 global
2100 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2101 feature}
2102 {not in Vi}
2103 Give messages when adding a cscope database. See |cscopeverbose|.
2104 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
2105
Bram Moolenaar600dddc2006-03-12 22:05:10 +00002106
2107 *'cursorcolumn'* *'cuc'* *'nocursorcolumn'* *'nocuc'*
2108'cursorcolumn' 'cuc' boolean (default off)
2109 local to window
2110 {not in Vi}
2111 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
2112 feature}
2113 Highlight the screen column of the cursor with CursorColumn
2114 |hl-CursorColumn|. Useful to align text. Will make screen redrawing
2115 slower.
Bram Moolenaar4c3f5362006-04-11 21:38:50 +00002116 If you only want the highlighting in the current window you can use
2117 these autocommands: >
2118 au WinLeave * set nocursorline nocursorcolumn
2119 au WinEnter * set cursorline cursorcolumn
2120<
Bram Moolenaar600dddc2006-03-12 22:05:10 +00002121
2122 *'cursorline'* *'cul'* *'nocursorline'* *'nocul'*
2123'cursorline' 'cul' boolean (default off)
2124 local to window
2125 {not in Vi}
2126 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
2127 feature}
2128 Highlight the screen line of the cursor with CursorLine
2129 |hl-CursorLine|. Useful to easily spot the cursor. Will make screen
2130 redrawing slower.
Bram Moolenaare2f98b92006-03-29 21:18:24 +00002131 When Visual mode is active the highlighting isn't used to make it
Bram Moolenaar779b74b2006-04-10 14:55:34 +00002132 easier to see the selected text.
Bram Moolenaar600dddc2006-03-12 22:05:10 +00002133
2134
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002135 *'debug'*
2136'debug' string (default "")
2137 global
2138 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00002139 These values can be used:
2140 msg Error messages that would otherwise be omitted will be given
2141 anyway.
2142 throw Error messages that would otherwise be omitted will be given
2143 anyway and also throw an exception and set |v:errmsg|.
2144 beep A message will be given when otherwise only a beep would be
2145 produced.
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00002146 The values can be combined, separated by a comma.
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00002147 "msg" and "throw" are useful for debugging 'foldexpr', 'formatexpr' or
2148 'indentexpr'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002149
2150 *'define'* *'def'*
2151'define' 'def' string (default "^\s*#\s*define")
2152 global or local to buffer |global-local|
2153 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002154 Pattern to be used to find a macro definition. It is a search
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002155 pattern, just like for the "/" command. This option is used for the
2156 commands like "[i" and "[d" |include-search|. The 'isident' option is
2157 used to recognize the defined name after the match:
2158 {match with 'define'}{non-ID chars}{defined name}{non-ID char}
2159 See |option-backslash| about inserting backslashes to include a space
2160 or backslash.
2161 The default value is for C programs. For C++ this value would be
2162 useful, to include const type declarations: >
2163 ^\(#\s*define\|[a-z]*\s*const\s*[a-z]*\)
2164< When using the ":set" command, you need to double the backslashes!
2165
2166 *'delcombine'* *'deco'* *'nodelcombine'* *'nodeco'*
2167'delcombine' 'deco' boolean (default off)
2168 global
2169 {not in Vi}
2170 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
2171 feature}
2172 If editing Unicode and this option is set, backspace and Normal mode
2173 "x" delete each combining character on its own. When it is off (the
2174 default) the character along with its combining characters are
2175 deleted.
2176 Note: When 'delcombine' is set "xx" may work different from "2x"!
2177
2178 This is useful for Arabic, Hebrew and many other languages where one
2179 may have combining characters overtop of base characters, and want
2180 to remove only the combining ones.
2181
2182 *'dictionary'* *'dict'*
2183'dictionary' 'dict' string (default "")
2184 global or local to buffer |global-local|
2185 {not in Vi}
2186 List of file names, separated by commas, that are used to lookup words
2187 for keyword completion commands |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K|. Each file should
2188 contain a list of words. This can be one word per line, or several
2189 words per line, separated by non-keyword characters (white space is
2190 preferred). Maximum line length is 510 bytes.
Bram Moolenaar0b238792006-03-02 22:49:12 +00002191 When this option is empty, or an entry "spell" is present, spell
2192 checking is enabled the currently active spelling is used. |spell|
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002193 To include a comma in a file name precede it with a backslash. Spaces
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002194 after a comma are ignored, otherwise spaces are included in the file
2195 name. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes.
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +00002196 This has nothing to do with the |Dictionary| variable type.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002197 Where to find a list of words?
2198 - On FreeBSD, there is the file "/usr/share/dict/words".
2199 - In the Simtel archive, look in the "msdos/linguist" directory.
2200 - In "miscfiles" of the GNU collection.
2201 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
2202 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
2203 uses another default.
2204 Backticks cannot be used in this option for security reasons.
2205
2206 *'diff'* *'nodiff'*
2207'diff' boolean (default off)
2208 local to window
2209 {not in Vi}
2210 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
2211 feature}
2212 Join the current window in the group of windows that shows differences
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002213 between files. See |vimdiff|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002214
2215 *'dex'* *'diffexpr'*
2216'diffexpr' 'dex' string (default "")
2217 global
2218 {not in Vi}
2219 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
2220 feature}
2221 Expression which is evaluated to obtain an ed-style diff file from two
2222 versions of a file. See |diff-diffexpr|.
2223 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
2224 security reasons.
2225
2226 *'dip'* *'diffopt'*
2227'diffopt' 'dip' string (default "filler")
2228 global
2229 {not in Vi}
2230 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
2231 feature}
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002232 Option settings for diff mode. It can consist of the following items.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002233 All are optional. Items must be separated by a comma.
2234
2235 filler Show filler lines, to keep the text
2236 synchronized with a window that has inserted
2237 lines at the same position. Mostly useful
2238 when windows are side-by-side and 'scrollbind'
2239 is set.
2240
2241 context:{n} Use a context of {n} lines between a change
2242 and a fold that contains unchanged lines.
2243 When omitted a context of six lines is used.
2244 See |fold-diff|.
2245
2246 icase Ignore changes in case of text. "a" and "A"
2247 are considered the same. Adds the "-i" flag
2248 to the "diff" command if 'diffexpr' is empty.
2249
2250 iwhite Ignore changes in amount of white space. Adds
2251 the "-b" flag to the "diff" command if
2252 'diffexpr' is empty. Check the documentation
2253 of the "diff" command for what this does
2254 exactly. It should ignore adding trailing
2255 white space, but not leading white space.
2256
Bram Moolenaar7d47b6e2006-03-15 22:59:18 +00002257 horizontal Start diff mode with horizontal splits (unless
2258 explicitly specified otherwise).
2259
2260 vertical Start diff mode with vertical splits (unless
2261 explicitly specified otherwise).
2262
2263 foldcolumn:{n} Set the 'foldcolumn' option to {n} when
2264 starting diff mode. Without this 2 is used.
2265
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002266 Examples: >
2267
2268 :set diffopt=filler,context:4
2269 :set diffopt=
Bram Moolenaar7d47b6e2006-03-15 22:59:18 +00002270 :set diffopt=filler,foldcolumn:3
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002271<
2272 *'digraph'* *'dg'* *'nodigraph'* *'nodg'*
2273'digraph' 'dg' boolean (default off)
2274 global
2275 {not in Vi}
2276 {not available when compiled without the |+digraphs|
2277 feature}
2278 Enable the entering of digraphs in Insert mode with {char1} <BS>
2279 {char2}. See |digraphs|.
2280 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
2281
2282 *'directory'* *'dir'*
2283'directory' 'dir' string (default for Amiga: ".,t:",
2284 for MS-DOS and Win32: ".,c:\tmp,c:\temp"
2285 for Unix: ".,~/tmp,/var/tmp,/tmp")
2286 global
2287 List of directory names for the swap file, separated with commas.
2288 - The swap file will be created in the first directory where this is
2289 possible.
2290 - Empty means that no swap file will be used (recovery is
2291 impossible!).
2292 - A directory "." means to put the swap file in the same directory as
2293 the edited file. On Unix, a dot is prepended to the file name, so
2294 it doesn't show in a directory listing. On MS-Windows the "hidden"
2295 attribute is set and a dot prepended if possible.
Bram Moolenaar009b2592004-10-24 19:18:58 +00002296 - A directory starting with "./" (or ".\" for MS-DOS et al.) means to
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002297 put the swap file relative to where the edited file is. The leading
2298 "." is replaced with the path name of the edited file.
Bram Moolenaar83bab712005-08-01 21:58:57 +00002299 - For Unix and Win32, if a directory ends in two path separators "//"
2300 or "\\", the swap file name will be built from the complete path to
2301 the file with all path separators substituted to percent '%' signs.
2302 This will ensure file name uniqueness in the preserve directory.
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00002303 On Win32, when a separating comma is following, you must use "//",
2304 since "\\" will include the comma in the file name.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002305 - Spaces after the comma are ignored, other spaces are considered part
2306 of the directory name. To have a space at the start of a directory
2307 name, precede it with a backslash.
2308 - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with a backslash.
2309 - A directory name may end in an ':' or '/'.
2310 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
2311 - Careful with '\' characters, type one before a space, type two to
2312 get one in the option (see |option-backslash|), for example: >
2313 :set dir=c:\\tmp,\ dir\\,with\\,commas,\\\ dir\ with\ spaces
2314< - For backwards compatibility with Vim version 3.0 a '>' at the start
2315 of the option is removed.
2316 Using "." first in the list is recommended. This means that editing
2317 the same file twice will result in a warning. Using "/tmp" on Unix is
2318 discouraged: When the system crashes you lose the swap file.
2319 "/var/tmp" is often not cleared when rebooting, thus is a better
2320 choice than "/tmp". But it can contain a lot of files, your swap
2321 files get lost in the crowd. That is why a "tmp" directory in your
2322 home directory is tried first.
2323 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
2324 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
2325 uses another default.
2326 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
2327 security reasons.
2328 {Vi: directory to put temp file in, defaults to "/tmp"}
2329
2330 *'display'* *'dy'*
2331'display' 'dy' string (default "")
2332 global
2333 {not in Vi}
2334 Change the way text is displayed. This is comma separated list of
2335 flags:
2336 lastline When included, as much as possible of the last line
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002337 in a window will be displayed. When not included, a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002338 last line that doesn't fit is replaced with "@" lines.
2339 uhex Show unprintable characters hexadecimal as <xx>
2340 instead of using ^C and ~C.
2341
2342 *'eadirection'* *'ead'*
2343'eadirection' 'ead' string (default "both")
2344 global
2345 {not in Vi}
2346 {not available when compiled without the +vertsplit
2347 feature}
2348 Tells when the 'equalalways' option applies:
2349 ver vertically, width of windows is not affected
2350 hor horizontally, height of windows is not affected
2351 both width and height of windows is affected
2352
2353 *'ed'* *'edcompatible'* *'noed'* *'noedcompatible'*
2354'edcompatible' 'ed' boolean (default off)
2355 global
2356 Makes the 'g' and 'c' flags of the ":substitute" command to be
2357 toggled each time the flag is given. See |complex-change|. See
2358 also 'gdefault' option.
2359 Switching this option on is discouraged!
2360
2361 *'encoding'* *'enc'* *E543*
2362'encoding' 'enc' string (default: "latin1" or value from $LANG)
2363 global
2364 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
2365 feature}
2366 {not in Vi}
2367 Sets the character encoding used inside Vim. It applies to text in
2368 the buffers, registers, Strings in expressions, text stored in the
2369 viminfo file, etc. It sets the kind of characters which Vim can work
2370 with. See |encoding-names| for the possible values.
2371
2372 NOTE: Changing this option will not change the encoding of the
Bram Moolenaar1cd871b2004-12-19 22:46:22 +00002373 existing text in Vim. It may cause non-ASCII text to become invalid.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002374 It should normally be kept at its default value, or set when Vim
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00002375 starts up. See |multibyte|. To reload the menus see |:menutrans|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002376
2377 NOTE: For GTK+ 2 it is highly recommended to set 'encoding' to
2378 "utf-8". Although care has been taken to allow different values of
2379 'encoding', "utf-8" is the natural choice for the environment and
2380 avoids unnecessary conversion overhead. "utf-8" has not been made
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002381 the default to prevent different behavior of the GUI and terminal
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002382 versions, and to avoid changing the encoding of newly created files
2383 without your knowledge (in case 'fileencodings' is empty).
2384
2385 The character encoding of files can be different from 'encoding'.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002386 This is specified with 'fileencoding'. The conversion is done with
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002387 iconv() or as specified with 'charconvert'.
2388
2389 Normally 'encoding' will be equal to your current locale. This will
2390 be the default if Vim recognizes your environment settings. If
2391 'encoding' is not set to the current locale, 'termencoding' must be
2392 set to convert typed and displayed text. See |encoding-table|.
2393
2394 When you set this option, it fires the |EncodingChanged| autocommand
2395 event so that you can set up fonts if necessary.
2396
2397 When the option is set, the value is converted to lowercase. Thus
2398 you can set it with uppercase values too. Underscores are translated
2399 to '-' signs.
2400 When the encoding is recognized, it is changed to the standard name.
2401 For example "Latin-1" becomes "latin1", "ISO_88592" becomes
2402 "iso-8859-2" and "utf8" becomes "utf-8".
2403
2404 Note: "latin1" is also used when the encoding could not be detected.
2405 This only works when editing files in the same encoding! When the
2406 actual character set is not latin1, make sure 'fileencoding' and
2407 'fileencodings' are empty. When conversion is needed, switch to using
2408 utf-8.
2409
2410 When "unicode", "ucs-2" or "ucs-4" is used, Vim internally uses utf-8.
2411 You don't notice this while editing, but it does matter for the
2412 |viminfo-file|. And Vim expects the terminal to use utf-8 too. Thus
2413 setting 'encoding' to one of these values instead of utf-8 only has
2414 effect for encoding used for files when 'fileencoding' is empty.
2415
Bram Moolenaar661b1822005-07-28 22:36:45 +00002416 When 'encoding' is set to a Unicode encoding, and 'fileencodings' was
2417 not set yet, the default for 'fileencodings' is changed.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002418
2419 *'endofline'* *'eol'* *'noendofline'* *'noeol'*
2420'endofline' 'eol' boolean (default on)
2421 local to buffer
2422 {not in Vi}
2423 When writing a file and this option is off and the 'binary' option
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002424 is on, no <EOL> will be written for the last line in the file. This
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002425 option is automatically set when starting to edit a new file, unless
2426 the file does not have an <EOL> for the last line in the file, in
2427 which case it is reset. Normally you don't have to set or reset this
2428 option. When 'binary' is off the value is not used when writing the
2429 file. When 'binary' is on it is used to remember the presence of a
2430 <EOL> for the last line in the file, so that when you write the file
2431 the situation from the original file can be kept. But you can change
2432 it if you want to.
2433
2434 *'equalalways'* *'ea'* *'noequalalways'* *'noea'*
2435'equalalways' 'ea' boolean (default on)
2436 global
2437 {not in Vi}
2438 When on, all the windows are automatically made the same size after
Bram Moolenaar009b2592004-10-24 19:18:58 +00002439 splitting or closing a window. This also happens the moment the
2440 option is switched on. When off, splitting a window will reduce the
2441 size of the current window and leave the other windows the same. When
2442 closing a window the extra lines are given to the window next to it
2443 (depending on 'splitbelow' and 'splitright').
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002444 When mixing vertically and horizontally split windows, a minimal size
2445 is computed and some windows may be larger if there is room. The
2446 'eadirection' option tells in which direction the size is affected.
Bram Moolenaar67f71312007-08-12 14:55:56 +00002447 Changing the height and width of a window can be avoided by setting
2448 'winfixheight' and 'winfixwidth', respectively.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002449
2450 *'equalprg'* *'ep'*
2451'equalprg' 'ep' string (default "")
2452 global or local to buffer |global-local|
2453 {not in Vi}
2454 External program to use for "=" command. When this option is empty
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00002455 the internal formatting functions are used; either 'lisp', 'cindent'
2456 or 'indentexpr'.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002457 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002458 about including spaces and backslashes.
2459 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
2460 security reasons.
2461
2462 *'errorbells'* *'eb'* *'noerrorbells'* *'noeb'*
2463'errorbells' 'eb' boolean (default off)
2464 global
2465 Ring the bell (beep or screen flash) for error messages. This only
2466 makes a difference for error messages, the bell will be used always
2467 for a lot of errors without a message (e.g., hitting <Esc> in Normal
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002468 mode). See 'visualbell' on how to make the bell behave like a beep,
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002469 screen flash or do nothing.
2470
2471 *'errorfile'* *'ef'*
2472'errorfile' 'ef' string (Amiga default: "AztecC.Err",
2473 others: "errors.err")
2474 global
2475 {not in Vi}
2476 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
2477 feature}
2478 Name of the errorfile for the QuickFix mode (see |:cf|).
2479 When the "-q" command-line argument is used, 'errorfile' is set to the
2480 following argument. See |-q|.
2481 NOT used for the ":make" command. See 'makeef' for that.
2482 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
2483 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
2484 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
2485 security reasons.
2486
2487 *'errorformat'* *'efm'*
2488'errorformat' 'efm' string (default is very long)
2489 global or local to buffer |global-local|
2490 {not in Vi}
2491 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
2492 feature}
2493 Scanf-like description of the format for the lines in the error file
2494 (see |errorformat|).
2495
2496 *'esckeys'* *'ek'* *'noesckeys'* *'noek'*
2497'esckeys' 'ek' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
2498 global
2499 {not in Vi}
2500 Function keys that start with an <Esc> are recognized in Insert
2501 mode. When this option is off, the cursor and function keys cannot be
2502 used in Insert mode if they start with an <Esc>. The advantage of
2503 this is that the single <Esc> is recognized immediately, instead of
2504 after one second. Instead of resetting this option, you might want to
2505 try changing the values for 'timeoutlen' and 'ttimeoutlen'. Note that
2506 when 'esckeys' is off, you can still map anything, but the cursor keys
2507 won't work by default.
2508 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
2509 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
2510
2511 *'eventignore'* *'ei'*
2512'eventignore' 'ei' string (default "")
2513 global
2514 {not in Vi}
2515 {not available when compiled without the |+autocmd|
2516 feature}
2517 A list of autocommand event names, which are to be ignored.
Bram Moolenaarf193fff2006-04-27 00:02:13 +00002518 When set to "all" or when "all" is one of the items, all autocommand
2519 events are ignored, autocommands will not be executed.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002520 Otherwise this is a comma separated list of event names. Example: >
2521 :set ei=WinEnter,WinLeave
2522<
2523 *'expandtab'* *'et'* *'noexpandtab'* *'noet'*
2524'expandtab' 'et' boolean (default off)
2525 local to buffer
2526 {not in Vi}
2527 In Insert mode: Use the appropriate number of spaces to insert a
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002528 <Tab>. Spaces are used in indents with the '>' and '<' commands and
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002529 when 'autoindent' is on. To insert a real tab when 'expandtab' is
2530 on, use CTRL-V<Tab>. See also |:retab| and |ins-expandtab|.
2531 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
2532
2533 *'exrc'* *'ex'* *'noexrc'* *'noex'*
2534'exrc' 'ex' boolean (default off)
2535 global
2536 {not in Vi}
2537 Enables the reading of .vimrc, .exrc and .gvimrc in the current
2538 directory. If you switch this option on you should also consider
2539 setting the 'secure' option (see |initialization|). Using a local
2540 .exrc, .vimrc or .gvimrc is a potential security leak, use with care!
2541 also see |.vimrc| and |gui-init|.
2542 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
2543 security reasons.
2544
2545 *'fileencoding'* *'fenc'* *E213*
2546'fileencoding' 'fenc' string (default: "")
2547 local to buffer
2548 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
2549 feature}
2550 {not in Vi}
2551 Sets the character encoding for the file of this buffer.
2552 When 'fileencoding' is different from 'encoding', conversion will be
2553 done when reading and writing the file.
2554 When 'fileencoding' is empty, the same value as 'encoding' will be
2555 used (no conversion when reading or writing a file).
2556 WARNING: Conversion can cause loss of information! When
2557 'encoding' is "utf-8" conversion is most likely done in a way
2558 that the reverse conversion results in the same text. When
2559 'encoding' is not "utf-8" some characters may be lost!
2560 See 'encoding' for the possible values. Additionally, values may be
2561 specified that can be handled by the converter, see
2562 |mbyte-conversion|.
2563 When reading a file 'fileencoding' will be set from 'fileencodings'.
2564 To read a file in a certain encoding it won't work by setting
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00002565 'fileencoding', use the |++enc| argument. One exception: when
2566 'fileencodings' is empty the value of 'fileencoding' is used.
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00002567 For a new file the global value of 'fileencoding' is used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002568 Prepending "8bit-" and "2byte-" has no meaning here, they are ignored.
2569 When the option is set, the value is converted to lowercase. Thus
2570 you can set it with uppercase values too. '_' characters are
2571 replaced with '-'. If a name is recognized from the list for
2572 'encoding', it is replaced by the standard name. For example
2573 "ISO8859-2" becomes "iso-8859-2".
2574 When this option is set, after starting to edit a file, the 'modified'
2575 option is set, because the file would be different when written.
2576 If you do this in a modeline, you might want to set 'nomodified' to
2577 avoid this.
2578 This option can not be changed when 'modifiable' is off.
2579
2580 *'fe'*
2581 NOTE: Before version 6.0 this option specified the encoding for the
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002582 whole of Vim, this was a mistake. Now use 'encoding' instead. The
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002583 old short name was 'fe', which is no longer used.
2584
2585 *'fileencodings'* *'fencs'*
Bram Moolenaar1cd871b2004-12-19 22:46:22 +00002586'fileencodings' 'fencs' string (default: "ucs-bom",
2587 "ucs-bom,utf-8,default,latin1" when
2588 'encoding' is set to a Unicode value)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002589 global
2590 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
2591 feature}
2592 {not in Vi}
2593 This is a list of character encodings considered when starting to edit
2594 an existing file. When a file is read, Vim tries to use the first
2595 mentioned character encoding. If an error is detected, the next one
2596 in the list is tried. When an encoding is found that works,
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002597 'fileencoding' is set to it. If all fail, 'fileencoding' is set to
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002598 an empty string, which means the value of 'encoding' is used.
2599 WARNING: Conversion can cause loss of information! When
2600 'encoding' is "utf-8" (or one of the other Unicode variants)
2601 conversion is most likely done in a way that the reverse
2602 conversion results in the same text. When 'encoding' is not
Bram Moolenaarc6d8db72005-12-13 20:04:55 +00002603 "utf-8" some non-ASCII characters may be lost! You can use
2604 the |++bad| argument to specify what is done with characters
2605 that can't be converted.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002606 For an empty file or a file with only ASCII characters most encodings
2607 will work and the first entry of 'fileencodings' will be used (except
2608 "ucs-bom", which requires the BOM to be present). If you prefer
2609 another encoding use an BufReadPost autocommand event to test if your
2610 preferred encoding is to be used. Example: >
2611 au BufReadPost * if search('\S', 'w') == 0 |
2612 \ set fenc=iso-2022-jp | endif
2613< This sets 'fileencoding' to "iso-2022-jp" if the file does not contain
2614 non-blank characters.
Bram Moolenaarc6d8db72005-12-13 20:04:55 +00002615 When the |++enc| argument is used then the value of 'fileencodings' is
2616 not used.
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00002617 Note that 'fileencodings' is not used for a new file, the global value
2618 of 'fileencoding' is used instead. You can set it with: >
2619 :setglobal fenc=iso-8859-2
2620< This means that a non-existing file may get a different encoding than
2621 an empty file.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002622 The special value "ucs-bom" can be used to check for a Unicode BOM
2623 (Byte Order Mark) at the start of the file. It must not be preceded
2624 by "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding for this to work properly.
2625 An entry for an 8-bit encoding (e.g., "latin1") should be the last,
2626 because Vim cannot detect an error, thus the encoding is always
2627 accepted.
Bram Moolenaar1cd871b2004-12-19 22:46:22 +00002628 The special value "default" can be used for the encoding from the
2629 environment. This is the default value for 'encoding'. It is useful
2630 when 'encoding' is set to "utf-8" and your environment uses a
2631 non-latin1 encoding, such as Russian.
Bram Moolenaarca003e12006-03-17 23:19:38 +00002632 When 'encoding' is "utf-8" and a file contains an illegal byte
2633 sequence it won't be recognized as UTF-8. You can use the |8g8|
2634 command to find the illegal byte sequence.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002635 WRONG VALUES: WHAT'S WRONG:
2636 latin1,utf-8 "latin1" will always be used
2637 utf-8,ucs-bom,latin1 BOM won't be recognized in an utf-8
2638 file
2639 cp1250,latin1 "cp1250" will always be used
2640 If 'fileencodings' is empty, 'fileencoding' is not modified.
2641 See 'fileencoding' for the possible values.
2642 Setting this option does not have an effect until the next time a file
2643 is read.
2644
2645 *'fileformat'* *'ff'*
2646'fileformat' 'ff' string (MS-DOS, MS-Windows, OS/2 default: "dos",
2647 Unix default: "unix",
2648 Macintosh default: "mac")
2649 local to buffer
2650 {not in Vi}
2651 This gives the <EOL> of the current buffer, which is used for
2652 reading/writing the buffer from/to a file:
2653 dos <CR> <NL>
2654 unix <NL>
2655 mac <CR>
2656 When "dos" is used, CTRL-Z at the end of a file is ignored.
2657 See |file-formats| and |file-read|.
2658 For the character encoding of the file see 'fileencoding'.
2659 When 'binary' is set, the value of 'fileformat' is ignored, file I/O
2660 works like it was set to "unix'.
2661 This option is set automatically when starting to edit a file and
2662 'fileformats' is not empty and 'binary' is off.
2663 When this option is set, after starting to edit a file, the 'modified'
2664 option is set, because the file would be different when written.
2665 This option can not be changed when 'modifiable' is off.
2666 For backwards compatibility: When this option is set to "dos",
2667 'textmode' is set, otherwise 'textmode' is reset.
2668
2669 *'fileformats'* *'ffs'*
2670'fileformats' 'ffs' string (default:
2671 Vim+Vi MS-DOS, MS-Windows OS/2: "dos,unix",
2672 Vim Unix: "unix,dos",
2673 Vim Mac: "mac,unix,dos",
2674 Vi Cygwin: "unix,dos",
2675 Vi others: "")
2676 global
2677 {not in Vi}
2678 This gives the end-of-line (<EOL>) formats that will be tried when
2679 starting to edit a new buffer and when reading a file into an existing
2680 buffer:
2681 - When empty, the format defined with 'fileformat' will be used
2682 always. It is not set automatically.
2683 - When set to one name, that format will be used whenever a new buffer
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002684 is opened. 'fileformat' is set accordingly for that buffer. The
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002685 'fileformats' name will be used when a file is read into an existing
2686 buffer, no matter what 'fileformat' for that buffer is set to.
2687 - When more than one name is present, separated by commas, automatic
2688 <EOL> detection will be done when reading a file. When starting to
2689 edit a file, a check is done for the <EOL>:
2690 1. If all lines end in <CR><NL>, and 'fileformats' includes "dos",
2691 'fileformat' is set to "dos".
2692 2. If a <NL> is found and 'fileformats' includes "unix", 'fileformat'
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002693 is set to "unix". Note that when a <NL> is found without a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002694 preceding <CR>, "unix" is preferred over "dos".
2695 3. If 'fileformats' includes "mac", 'fileformat' is set to "mac".
2696 This means that "mac" is only chosen when "unix" is not present,
2697 or when no <NL> is found in the file, and when "dos" is not
2698 present, or no <CR><NL> is present in the file.
2699 Also if "unix" was first chosen, but the first <CR> is before
2700 the first <NL> and there appears to be more <CR>'s than <NL>'s in
2701 the file, then 'fileformat' is set to "mac".
2702 4. If 'fileformat' is still not set, the first name from
2703 'fileformats' is used.
2704 When reading a file into an existing buffer, the same is done, but
2705 this happens like 'fileformat' has been set appropriately for that
2706 file only, the option is not changed.
2707 When 'binary' is set, the value of 'fileformats' is not used.
2708
2709 For systems with a Dos-like <EOL> (<CR><NL>), when reading files that
2710 are ":source"ed and for vimrc files, automatic <EOL> detection may be
2711 done:
2712 - When 'fileformats' is empty, there is no automatic detection. Dos
2713 format will be used.
2714 - When 'fileformats' is set to one or more names, automatic detection
2715 is done. This is based on the first <NL> in the file: If there is a
2716 <CR> in front of it, Dos format is used, otherwise Unix format is
2717 used.
2718 Also see |file-formats|.
2719 For backwards compatibility: When this option is set to an empty
2720 string or one format (no comma is included), 'textauto' is reset,
2721 otherwise 'textauto' is set.
2722 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
2723 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
2724
2725 *'filetype'* *'ft'*
2726'filetype' 'ft' string (default: "")
2727 local to buffer
2728 {not in Vi}
2729 {not available when compiled without the |+autocmd|
2730 feature}
2731 When this option is set, the FileType autocommand event is triggered.
2732 All autocommands that match with the value of this option will be
2733 executed. Thus the value of 'filetype' is used in place of the file
2734 name.
2735 Otherwise this option does not always reflect the current file type.
2736 This option is normally set when the file type is detected. To enable
2737 this use the ":filetype on" command. |:filetype|
2738 Setting this option to a different value is most useful in a modeline,
2739 for a file for which the file type is not automatically recognized.
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00002740 Example, for in an IDL file:
2741 /* vim: set filetype=idl : */ ~
2742 |FileType| |filetypes|
2743 When a dot appears in the value then this separates two filetype
2744 names. Example:
2745 /* vim: set filetype=c.doxygen : */ ~
2746 This will use the "c" filetype first, then the "doxygen" filetype.
2747 This works both for filetype plugins and for syntax files. More than
2748 one dot may appear.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002749 Do not confuse this option with 'osfiletype', which is for the file
2750 type that is actually stored with the file.
2751 This option is not copied to another buffer, independent of the 's' or
2752 'S' flag in 'cpoptions'.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00002753 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002754
2755 *'fillchars'* *'fcs'*
2756'fillchars' 'fcs' string (default "vert:|,fold:-")
2757 global
2758 {not in Vi}
2759 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
2760 and |+folding| features}
2761 Characters to fill the statuslines and vertical separators.
2762 It is a comma separated list of items:
2763
2764 item default Used for ~
2765 stl:c ' ' or '^' statusline of the current window
2766 stlnc:c ' ' or '-' statusline of the non-current windows
2767 vert:c '|' vertical separators |:vsplit|
2768 fold:c '-' filling 'foldtext'
2769 diff:c '-' deleted lines of the 'diff' option
2770
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002771 Any one that is omitted will fall back to the default. For "stl" and
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002772 "stlnc" the space will be used when there is highlighting, '^' or '-'
2773 otherwise.
2774
2775 Example: >
2776 :set fillchars=stl:^,stlnc:-,vert:\|,fold:-,diff:-
2777< This is similar to the default, except that these characters will also
2778 be used when there is highlighting.
2779
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00002780 for "stl" and "stlnc" only single-byte values are supported.
2781
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002782 The highlighting used for these items:
2783 item highlight group ~
2784 stl:c StatusLine |hl-StatusLine|
2785 stlnc:c StatusLineNC |hl-StatusLineNC|
2786 vert:c VertSplit |hl-VertSplit|
2787 fold:c Folded |hl-Folded|
2788 diff:c DiffDelete |hl-DiffDelete|
2789
2790 *'fkmap'* *'fk'* *'nofkmap'* *'nofk'*
2791'fkmap' 'fk' boolean (default off) *E198*
2792 global
2793 {not in Vi}
2794 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
2795 feature}
2796 When on, the keyboard is mapped for the Farsi character set.
2797 Normally you would set 'allowrevins' and use CTRL-_ in insert mode to
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002798 toggle this option |i_CTRL-_|. See |farsi.txt|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002799
2800 *'foldclose'* *'fcl'*
2801'foldclose' 'fcl' string (default "")
2802 global
2803 {not in Vi}
2804 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
2805 feature}
2806 When set to "all", a fold is closed when the cursor isn't in it and
2807 its level is higher than 'foldlevel'. Useful if you want folds to
2808 automatically close when moving out of them.
2809
2810 *'foldcolumn'* *'fdc'*
2811'foldcolumn' 'fdc' number (default 0)
2812 local to window
2813 {not in Vi}
2814 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
2815 feature}
2816 When non-zero, a column with the specified width is shown at the side
2817 of the window which indicates open and closed folds. The maximum
2818 value is 12.
2819 See |folding|.
2820
2821 *'foldenable'* *'fen'* *'nofoldenable'* *'nofen'*
2822'foldenable' 'fen' boolean (default on)
2823 local to window
2824 {not in Vi}
2825 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
2826 feature}
2827 When off, all folds are open. This option can be used to quickly
2828 switch between showing all text unfolded and viewing the text with
2829 folds (including manually opened or closed folds). It can be toggled
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002830 with the |zi| command. The 'foldcolumn' will remain blank when
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002831 'foldenable' is off.
2832 This option is set by commands that create a new fold or close a fold.
2833 See |folding|.
2834
2835 *'foldexpr'* *'fde'*
2836'foldexpr' 'fde' string (default: "0")
2837 local to window
2838 {not in Vi}
2839 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
2840 or |+eval| feature}
2841 The expression used for when 'foldmethod' is "expr". It is evaluated
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00002842 for each line to obtain its fold level. See |fold-expr|.
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00002843
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00002844 The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
2845 |sandbox-option|.
2846
2847 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
2848 evaluating 'foldexpr' |textlock|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002849
2850 *'foldignore'* *'fdi'*
2851'foldignore' 'fdi' string (default: "#")
2852 local to window
2853 {not in Vi}
2854 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
2855 feature}
2856 Used only when 'foldmethod' is "indent". Lines starting with
2857 characters in 'foldignore' will get their fold level from surrounding
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002858 lines. White space is skipped before checking for this character.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002859 The default "#" works well for C programs. See |fold-indent|.
2860
2861 *'foldlevel'* *'fdl'*
2862'foldlevel' 'fdl' number (default: 0)
2863 local to window
2864 {not in Vi}
2865 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
2866 feature}
2867 Sets the fold level: Folds with a higher level will be closed.
2868 Setting this option to zero will close all folds. Higher numbers will
2869 close fewer folds.
2870 This option is set by commands like |zm|, |zM| and |zR|.
2871 See |fold-foldlevel|.
2872
2873 *'foldlevelstart'* *'fdls'*
2874'foldlevelstart' 'fdls' number (default: -1)
2875 global
2876 {not in Vi}
2877 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
2878 feature}
2879 Sets 'foldlevel' when starting to edit another buffer in a window.
2880 Useful to always start editing with all folds closed (value zero),
2881 some folds closed (one) or no folds closed (99).
2882 This is done before reading any modeline, thus a setting in a modeline
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002883 overrules this option. Starting to edit a file for |diff-mode| also
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002884 ignores this option and closes all folds.
2885 It is also done before BufReadPre autocommands, to allow an autocmd to
2886 overrule the 'foldlevel' value for specific files.
2887 When the value is negative, it is not used.
2888
2889 *'foldmarker'* *'fmr'* *E536*
2890'foldmarker' 'fmr' string (default: "{{{,}}}")
2891 local to window
2892 {not in Vi}
2893 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
2894 feature}
2895 The start and end marker used when 'foldmethod' is "marker". There
2896 must be one comma, which separates the start and end marker. The
2897 marker is a literal string (a regular expression would be too slow).
2898 See |fold-marker|.
2899
2900 *'foldmethod'* *'fdm'*
2901'foldmethod' 'fdm' string (default: "manual")
2902 local to window
2903 {not in Vi}
2904 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
2905 feature}
2906 The kind of folding used for the current window. Possible values:
2907 |fold-manual| manual Folds are created manually.
2908 |fold-indent| indent Lines with equal indent form a fold.
2909 |fold-expr| expr 'foldexpr' gives the fold level of a line.
2910 |fold-marker| marker Markers are used to specify folds.
2911 |fold-syntax| syntax Syntax highlighting items specify folds.
2912 |fold-diff| diff Fold text that is not changed.
2913
2914 *'foldminlines'* *'fml'*
2915'foldminlines' 'fml' number (default: 1)
2916 local to window
2917 {not in Vi}
2918 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
2919 feature}
2920 Sets the minimum number of screen lines for a fold to be displayed
2921 closed. Also for manually closed folds.
2922 Note that this only has an effect of what is displayed. After using
2923 "zc" to close a fold, which is displayed open because it's smaller
2924 than 'foldminlines', a following "zc" may close a containing fold.
2925
2926 *'foldnestmax'* *'fdn'*
2927'foldnestmax' 'fdn' number (default: 20)
2928 local to window
2929 {not in Vi}
2930 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
2931 feature}
2932 Sets the maximum nesting of folds for the "indent" and "syntax"
2933 methods. This avoids that too many folds will be created. Using more
2934 than 20 doesn't work, because the internal limit is 20.
2935
2936 *'foldopen'* *'fdo'*
2937'foldopen' 'fdo' string (default: "block,hor,mark,percent,quickfix,
2938 search,tag,undo")
2939 global
2940 {not in Vi}
2941 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
2942 feature}
2943 Specifies for which type of commands folds will be opened, if the
2944 command moves the cursor into a closed fold. It is a comma separated
2945 list of items.
2946 item commands ~
2947 all any
2948 block "(", "{", "[[", "[{", etc.
2949 hor horizontal movements: "l", "w", "fx", etc.
2950 insert any command in Insert mode
2951 jump far jumps: "G", "gg", etc.
2952 mark jumping to a mark: "'m", CTRL-O, etc.
2953 percent "%"
2954 quickfix ":cn", ":crew", ":make", etc.
2955 search search for a pattern: "/", "n", "*", "gd", etc.
2956 (not for a search pattern in a ":" command)
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00002957 Also for |[s| and |]s|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002958 tag jumping to a tag: ":ta", CTRL-T, etc.
2959 undo undo or redo: "u" and CTRL-R
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002960 When the command is part of a mapping this option is not used. Add
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002961 the |zv| command to the mapping to get the same effect.
2962 When a movement command is used for an operator (e.g., "dl" or "y%")
2963 this option is not used. This means the operator will include the
2964 whole closed fold.
2965 Note that vertical movements are not here, because it would make it
2966 very difficult to move onto a closed fold.
2967 In insert mode the folds containing the cursor will always be open
2968 when text is inserted.
2969 To close folds you can re-apply 'foldlevel' with the |zx| command or
2970 set the 'foldclose' option to "all".
2971
2972 *'foldtext'* *'fdt'*
2973'foldtext' 'fdt' string (default: "foldtext()")
2974 local to window
2975 {not in Vi}
2976 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
2977 feature}
2978 An expression which is used to specify the text displayed for a closed
2979 fold. See |fold-foldtext|.
2980
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00002981 The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
2982 |sandbox-option|.
2983
2984 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
2985 evaluating 'foldtext' |textlock|.
2986
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002987 *'formatoptions'* *'fo'*
2988'formatoptions' 'fo' string (Vim default: "tcq", Vi default: "vt")
2989 local to buffer
2990 {not in Vi}
2991 This is a sequence of letters which describes how automatic
2992 formatting is to be done. See |fo-table|. When the 'paste' option is
2993 on, no formatting is done (like 'formatoptions' is empty). Commas can
2994 be inserted for readability.
2995 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the
2996 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|.
2997 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
2998 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
2999
Bram Moolenaar86b68352004-12-27 21:59:20 +00003000 *'formatlistpat'* *'flp'*
3001'formatlistpat' 'flp' string (default: "^\s*\d\+[\]:.)}\t ]\s*")
3002 local to buffer
3003 {not in Vi}
3004 A pattern that is used to recognize a list header. This is used for
3005 the "n" flag in 'formatoptions'.
3006 The pattern must match exactly the text that will be the indent for
Bram Moolenaar677ee682005-01-27 14:41:15 +00003007 the line below it. You can use |/\ze| to mark the end of the match
Bram Moolenaar86b68352004-12-27 21:59:20 +00003008 while still checking more characters. There must be a character
3009 following the pattern, when it matches the whole line it is handled
3010 like there is no match.
3011 The default recognizes a number, followed by an optional punctuation
3012 character and white space.
3013
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003014 *'formatprg'* *'fp'*
3015'formatprg' 'fp' string (default "")
3016 global
3017 {not in Vi}
3018 The name of an external program that will be used to format the lines
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +00003019 selected with the |gq| operator. The program must take the input on
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003020 stdin and produce the output on stdout. The Unix program "fmt" is
Bram Moolenaara5792f52005-11-23 21:25:05 +00003021 such a program.
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +00003022 If the 'formatexpr' option is not empty it will be used instead.
3023 Otherwise, if 'formatprg' option is an empty string, the internal
3024 format function will be used |C-indenting|.
Bram Moolenaara5792f52005-11-23 21:25:05 +00003025 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash|
3026 about including spaces and backslashes.
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +00003027 The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
3028 |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003029
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +00003030 *'formatexpr'* *'fex'*
3031'formatexpr' 'fex' string (default "")
3032 local to buffer
3033 {not in Vi}
3034 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
3035 feature}
3036 Expression which is evaluated to format a range of lines for the |gq|
Bram Moolenaarf193fff2006-04-27 00:02:13 +00003037 operator. When this option is empty 'formatprg' is used.
3038
3039 The |v:lnum| variable holds the first line to be formatted.
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00003040 The |v:count| variable holds the number of lines to be formatted.
3041 The |v:char| variable holds the character that is going to be
3042 inserted. This can be empty. Don't insert it yet!
Bram Moolenaarf193fff2006-04-27 00:02:13 +00003043
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +00003044 Example: >
Bram Moolenaard1f56e62006-02-22 21:25:37 +00003045 :set formatexpr=mylang#Format()
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +00003046< This will invoke the mylang#Format() function in the
3047 autoload/mylang.vim file in 'runtimepath'. |autoload|
3048
3049 The expression is also evaluated when 'textwidth' is set and adding
3050 text beyond that limit. This happens under the same conditions as
3051 when internal formatting is used. Make sure the cursor is kept in the
3052 same spot relative to the text then! The |mode()| function will
3053 return "i" or "R" in this situation. When the function returns
3054 non-zero Vim will fall back to using the internal format mechanism.
3055
3056 The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
3057 |sandbox-option|.
3058
3059 *'fsync'* *'fs'*
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00003060'fsync' 'fs' boolean (default on)
3061 global
3062 {not in Vi}
3063 When on, the library function fsync() will be called after writing a
3064 file. This will flush a file to disk, ensuring that it is safely
3065 written even on filesystems which do metadata-only journaling. This
3066 will force the harddrive to spin up on Linux systems running in laptop
3067 mode, so it may be undesirable in some situations. Be warned that
3068 turning this off increases the chances of data loss after a crash. On
3069 systems without an fsync() implementation, this variable is always
3070 off.
3071 Also see 'swapsync' for controlling fsync() on swap files.
3072
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003073 *'gdefault'* *'gd'* *'nogdefault'* *'nogd'*
3074'gdefault' 'gd' boolean (default off)
3075 global
3076 {not in Vi}
3077 When on, the ":substitute" flag 'g' is default on. This means that
3078 all matches in a line are substituted instead of one. When a 'g' flag
3079 is given to a ":substitute" command, this will toggle the substitution
3080 of all or one match. See |complex-change|.
3081
3082 command 'gdefault' on 'gdefault' off ~
3083 :s/// subst. all subst. one
3084 :s///g subst. one subst. all
3085 :s///gg subst. all subst. one
3086
3087 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3088
3089 *'grepformat'* *'gfm'*
3090'grepformat' 'gfm' string (default "%f:%l%m,%f %l%m")
3091 global
3092 {not in Vi}
3093 Format to recognize for the ":grep" command output.
3094 This is a scanf-like string that uses the same format as the
3095 'errorformat' option: see |errorformat|.
3096
3097 *'grepprg'* *'gp'*
3098'grepprg' 'gp' string (default "grep -n ",
3099 Unix: "grep -n $* /dev/null",
3100 Win32: "findstr /n" or "grep -n",
3101 VMS: "SEARCH/NUMBERS ")
3102 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3103 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00003104 Program to use for the |:grep| command. This option may contain '%'
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003105 and '#' characters, which are expanded like when used in a command-
3106 line. The placeholder "$*" is allowed to specify where the arguments
3107 will be included. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See
3108 |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
3109 When your "grep" accepts the "-H" argument, use this to make ":grep"
3110 also work well with a single file: >
3111 :set grepprg=grep\ -nH
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00003112< Special value: When 'grepprg' is set to "internal" the |:grep| command
Bram Moolenaara6557602006-02-04 22:43:20 +00003113 works like |:vimgrep|, |:lgrep| like |:lvimgrep|, |:grepadd| like
3114 |:vimgrepadd| and |:lgrepadd| like |:lvimgrepadd|.
Bram Moolenaar86b68352004-12-27 21:59:20 +00003115 See also the section |:make_makeprg|, since most of the comments there
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003116 apply equally to 'grepprg'.
3117 For Win32, the default is "findstr /n" if "findstr.exe" can be found,
3118 otherwise it's "grep -n".
3119 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3120 security reasons.
3121
3122 *'guicursor'* *'gcr'* *E545* *E546* *E548* *E549*
3123'guicursor' 'gcr' string (default "n-v-c:block-Cursor/lCursor,
3124 ve:ver35-Cursor,
3125 o:hor50-Cursor,
3126 i-ci:ver25-Cursor/lCursor,
3127 r-cr:hor20-Cursor/lCursor,
3128 sm:block-Cursor
3129 -blinkwait175-blinkoff150-blinkon175",
3130 for MS-DOS and Win32 console:
3131 "n-v-c:block,o:hor50,i-ci:hor15,
3132 r-cr:hor30,sm:block")
3133 global
3134 {not in Vi}
3135 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled, and
3136 for MS-DOS and Win32 console}
3137 This option tells Vim what the cursor should look like in different
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003138 modes. It fully works in the GUI. In an MSDOS or Win32 console, only
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003139 the height of the cursor can be changed. This can be done by
3140 specifying a block cursor, or a percentage for a vertical or
3141 horizontal cursor.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00003142 For a console the 't_SI' and 't_EI' escape sequences are used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003143
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003144 The option is a comma separated list of parts. Each part consist of a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003145 mode-list and an argument-list:
3146 mode-list:argument-list,mode-list:argument-list,..
3147 The mode-list is a dash separated list of these modes:
3148 n Normal mode
3149 v Visual mode
3150 ve Visual mode with 'selection' "exclusive" (same as 'v',
3151 if not specified)
3152 o Operator-pending mode
3153 i Insert mode
3154 r Replace mode
3155 c Command-line Normal (append) mode
3156 ci Command-line Insert mode
3157 cr Command-line Replace mode
3158 sm showmatch in Insert mode
3159 a all modes
3160 The argument-list is a dash separated list of these arguments:
3161 hor{N} horizontal bar, {N} percent of the character height
3162 ver{N} vertical bar, {N} percent of the character width
3163 block block cursor, fills the whole character
3164 [only one of the above three should be present]
3165 blinkwait{N} *cursor-blinking*
3166 blinkon{N}
3167 blinkoff{N}
3168 blink times for cursor: blinkwait is the delay before
3169 the cursor starts blinking, blinkon is the time that
3170 the cursor is shown and blinkoff is the time that the
3171 cursor is not shown. The times are in msec. When one
3172 of the numbers is zero, there is no blinking. The
3173 default is: "blinkwait700-blinkon400-blinkoff250".
3174 These numbers are used for a missing entry. This
3175 means that blinking is enabled by default. To switch
3176 blinking off you can use "blinkon0". The cursor only
3177 blinks when Vim is waiting for input, not while
3178 executing a command.
3179 To make the cursor blink in an xterm, see
3180 |xterm-blink|.
3181 {group-name}
3182 a highlight group name, that sets the color and font
3183 for the cursor
3184 {group-name}/{group-name}
3185 Two highlight group names, the first is used when
3186 no language mappings are used, the other when they
3187 are. |language-mapping|
3188
3189 Examples of parts:
3190 n-c-v:block-nCursor in Normal, Command-line and Visual mode, use a
3191 block cursor with colors from the "nCursor"
3192 highlight group
3193 i-ci:ver30-iCursor-blinkwait300-blinkon200-blinkoff150
3194 In Insert and Command-line Insert mode, use a
3195 30% vertical bar cursor with colors from the
3196 "iCursor" highlight group. Blink a bit
3197 faster.
3198
3199 The 'a' mode is different. It will set the given argument-list for
3200 all modes. It does not reset anything to defaults. This can be used
3201 to do a common setting for all modes. For example, to switch off
3202 blinking: "a:blinkon0"
3203
3204 Examples of cursor highlighting: >
3205 :highlight Cursor gui=reverse guifg=NONE guibg=NONE
3206 :highlight Cursor gui=NONE guifg=bg guibg=fg
3207<
3208 *'guifont'* *'gfn'*
3209 *E235* *E596* *E610* *E611*
3210'guifont' 'gfn' string (default "")
3211 global
3212 {not in Vi}
3213 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
3214 This is a list of fonts which will be used for the GUI version of Vim.
3215 In its simplest form the value is just one font name. When
3216 the font cannot be found you will get an error message. To try other
3217 font names a list can be specified, font names separated with commas.
3218 The first valid font is used.
Bram Moolenaared203462004-06-16 11:19:22 +00003219
Bram Moolenaar05159a02005-02-26 23:04:13 +00003220 On systems where 'guifontset' is supported (X11) and 'guifontset' is
3221 not empty, then 'guifont' is not used.
Bram Moolenaared203462004-06-16 11:19:22 +00003222
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003223 Spaces after a comma are ignored. To include a comma in a font name
3224 precede it with a backslash. Setting an option requires an extra
3225 backslash before a space and a backslash. See also
3226 |option-backslash|. For example: >
3227 :set guifont=Screen15,\ 7x13,font\\,with\\,commas
Bram Moolenaared203462004-06-16 11:19:22 +00003228< will make Vim try to use the font "Screen15" first, and if it fails it
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003229 will try to use "7x13" and then "font,with,commas" instead.
Bram Moolenaared203462004-06-16 11:19:22 +00003230
3231 If none of the fonts can be loaded, Vim will keep the current setting.
3232 If an empty font list is given, Vim will try using other resource
3233 settings (for X, it will use the Vim.font resource), and finally it
3234 will try some builtin default which should always be there ("7x13" in
3235 the case of X). The font names given should be "normal" fonts. Vim
3236 will try to find the related bold and italic fonts.
3237
Bram Moolenaar05159a02005-02-26 23:04:13 +00003238 For Win32, GTK, Mac OS and Photon: >
Bram Moolenaared203462004-06-16 11:19:22 +00003239 :set guifont=*
3240< will bring up a font requester, where you can pick the font you want.
3241
3242 The font name depends on the GUI used. See |setting-guifont| for a
3243 way to set 'guifont' for various systems.
3244
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003245 For the GTK+ 2 GUI the font name looks like this: >
3246 :set guifont=Andale\ Mono\ 11
3247< That's all. XLFDs are no longer accepted.
Bram Moolenaar05159a02005-02-26 23:04:13 +00003248
3249 For Mac OSX you can use something like this: >
3250 :set guifont=Monaco:h10
Bram Moolenaar06a89a52006-04-29 22:01:03 +00003251< Also see 'macatsui', it can help fix display problems.
3252 *E236*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003253 Note that the fonts must be mono-spaced (all characters have the same
Bram Moolenaared203462004-06-16 11:19:22 +00003254 width). An exception is GTK 2: all fonts are accepted, but
3255 mono-spaced fonts look best.
3256
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003257 To preview a font on X11, you might be able to use the "xfontsel"
3258 program. The "xlsfonts" program gives a list of all available fonts.
Bram Moolenaared203462004-06-16 11:19:22 +00003259
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003260 For the Win32 GUI *E244* *E245*
3261 - takes these options in the font name:
3262 hXX - height is XX (points, can be floating-point)
3263 wXX - width is XX (points, can be floating-point)
3264 b - bold
3265 i - italic
3266 u - underline
3267 s - strikeout
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00003268 cXX - character set XX. Valid charsets are: ANSI, ARABIC,
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003269 BALTIC, CHINESEBIG5, DEFAULT, EASTEUROPE, GB2312, GREEK,
3270 HANGEUL, HEBREW, JOHAB, MAC, OEM, RUSSIAN, SHIFTJIS,
3271 SYMBOL, THAI, TURKISH, VIETNAMESE ANSI and BALTIC.
Bram Moolenaard4755bb2004-09-02 19:12:26 +00003272 Normally you would use "cDEFAULT".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003273
3274 Use a ':' to separate the options.
3275 - A '_' can be used in the place of a space, so you don't need to use
3276 backslashes to escape the spaces.
3277 - Examples: >
3278 :set guifont=courier_new:h12:w5:b:cRUSSIAN
3279 :set guifont=Andale_Mono:h7.5:w4.5
3280< See also |font-sizes|.
3281
3282 *'guifontset'* *'gfs'*
3283 *E250* *E252* *E234* *E597* *E598*
3284'guifontset' 'gfs' string (default "")
3285 global
3286 {not in Vi}
3287 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled and
3288 with the |+xfontset| feature}
3289 {not available in the GTK+ 2 GUI}
3290 When not empty, specifies two (or more) fonts to be used. The first
3291 one for normal English, the second one for your special language. See
3292 |xfontset|.
3293 Setting this option also means that all font names will be handled as
3294 a fontset name. Also the ones used for the "font" argument of the
3295 |:highlight| command.
3296 The fonts must match with the current locale. If fonts for the
3297 character sets that the current locale uses are not included, setting
3298 'guifontset' will fail.
3299 Note the difference between 'guifont' and 'guifontset': In 'guifont'
3300 the comma-separated names are alternative names, one of which will be
3301 used. In 'guifontset' the whole string is one fontset name,
3302 including the commas. It is not possible to specify alternative
3303 fontset names.
3304 This example works on many X11 systems: >
3305 :set guifontset=-*-*-medium-r-normal--16-*-*-*-c-*-*-*
3306<
3307 *'guifontwide'* *'gfw'* *E231* *E533* *E534*
3308'guifontwide' 'gfw' string (default "")
3309 global
3310 {not in Vi}
3311 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
3312 When not empty, specifies a comma-separated list of fonts to be used
3313 for double-width characters. The first font that can be loaded is
3314 used.
3315 Note: The size of these fonts must be exactly twice as wide as the one
3316 specified with 'guifont' and the same height.
3317
3318 All GUI versions but GTK+ 2:
3319
3320 'guifontwide' is only used when 'encoding' is set to "utf-8" and
3321 'guifontset' is empty or invalid.
3322 When 'guifont' is set and a valid font is found in it and
3323 'guifontwide' is empty Vim will attempt to find a matching
3324 double-width font and set 'guifontwide' to it.
3325
3326 GTK+ 2 GUI only: *guifontwide_gtk2*
3327
3328 If set and valid, 'guifontwide' is always used for double width
3329 characters, even if 'encoding' is not set to "utf-8".
3330 Vim does not attempt to find an appropriate value for 'guifontwide'
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003331 automatically. If 'guifontwide' is empty Pango/Xft will choose the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003332 font for characters not available in 'guifont'. Thus you do not need
3333 to set 'guifontwide' at all unless you want to override the choice
3334 made by Pango/Xft.
3335
3336 *'guiheadroom'* *'ghr'*
3337'guiheadroom' 'ghr' number (default 50)
3338 global
3339 {not in Vi} {only for GTK and X11 GUI}
3340 The number of pixels subtracted from the screen height when fitting
3341 the GUI window on the screen. Set this before the GUI is started,
3342 e.g., in your |gvimrc| file. When zero, the whole screen height will
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003343 be used by the window. When positive, the specified number of pixel
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003344 lines will be left for window decorations and other items on the
3345 screen. Set it to a negative value to allow windows taller than the
3346 screen.
3347
3348 *'guioptions'* *'go'*
3349'guioptions' 'go' string (default "gmrLtT" (MS-Windows),
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00003350 "agimrLtT" (GTK, Motif and Athena))
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003351 global
3352 {not in Vi}
3353 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
Bram Moolenaared203462004-06-16 11:19:22 +00003354 This option only has an effect in the GUI version of Vim. It is a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003355 sequence of letters which describes what components and options of the
3356 GUI should be used.
3357 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the
3358 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|.
3359
3360 Valid letters are as follows:
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003361 *guioptions_a* *'go-a'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003362 'a' Autoselect: If present, then whenever VISUAL mode is started,
3363 or the Visual area extended, Vim tries to become the owner of
3364 the windowing system's global selection. This means that the
3365 Visually highlighted text is available for pasting into other
3366 applications as well as into Vim itself. When the Visual mode
3367 ends, possibly due to an operation on the text, or when an
3368 application wants to paste the selection, the highlighted text
3369 is automatically yanked into the "* selection register.
3370 Thus the selection is still available for pasting into other
3371 applications after the VISUAL mode has ended.
3372 If not present, then Vim won't become the owner of the
3373 windowing system's global selection unless explicitly told to
3374 by a yank or delete operation for the "* register.
3375 The same applies to the modeless selection.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003376 *'go-A'*
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003377 'A' Autoselect for the modeless selection. Like 'a', but only
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003378 applies to the modeless selection.
3379
3380 'guioptions' autoselect Visual autoselect modeless ~
3381 "" - -
3382 "a" yes yes
3383 "A" - yes
3384 "aA" yes yes
3385
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003386 *'go-c'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003387 'c' Use console dialogs instead of popup dialogs for simple
3388 choices.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003389 *'go-e'*
Bram Moolenaare224ffa2006-03-01 00:01:28 +00003390 'e' Add tab pages when indicated with 'showtabline'.
Bram Moolenaar5c8837f2006-02-25 21:52:33 +00003391 'guitablabel' can be used to change the text in the labels.
3392 When 'e' is missing a non-GUI tab pages line may be used.
Bram Moolenaard68071d2006-05-02 22:08:30 +00003393 The GUI tabs are only supported on some systems, currently
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00003394 GTK, Motif, Mac OS/X and MS-Windows.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003395 *'go-f'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003396 'f' Foreground: Don't use fork() to detach the GUI from the shell
3397 where it was started. Use this for programs that wait for the
3398 editor to finish (e.g., an e-mail program). Alternatively you
3399 can use "gvim -f" or ":gui -f" to start the GUI in the
3400 foreground. |gui-fork|
3401 Note: Set this option in the vimrc file. The forking may have
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00003402 happened already when the |gvimrc| file is read.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003403 *'go-i'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003404 'i' Use a Vim icon. For GTK with KDE it is used in the left-upper
3405 corner of the window. It's black&white on non-GTK, because of
3406 limitations of X11. For a color icon, see |X11-icon|.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003407 *'go-m'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003408 'm' Menu bar is present.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003409 *'go-M'*
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003410 'M' The system menu "$VIMRUNTIME/menu.vim" is not sourced. Note
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003411 that this flag must be added in the .vimrc file, before
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00003412 switching on syntax or filetype recognition (when the |gvimrc|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003413 file is sourced the system menu has already been loaded; the
3414 ":syntax on" and ":filetype on" commands load the menu too).
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003415 *'go-g'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003416 'g' Grey menu items: Make menu items that are not active grey. If
3417 'g' is not included inactive menu items are not shown at all.
3418 Exception: Athena will always use grey menu items.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003419 *'go-t'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003420 't' Include tearoff menu items. Currently only works for Win32,
3421 GTK+, and Motif 1.2 GUI.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003422 *'go-T'*
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00003423 'T' Include Toolbar. Currently only in Win32, GTK+, Motif, Photon
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00003424 and Athena GUIs.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003425 *'go-r'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003426 'r' Right-hand scrollbar is always present.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003427 *'go-R'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003428 'R' Right-hand scrollbar is present when there is a vertically
3429 split window.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003430 *'go-l'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003431 'l' Left-hand scrollbar is always present.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003432 *'go-L'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003433 'L' Left-hand scrollbar is present when there is a vertically
3434 split window.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003435 *'go-b'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003436 'b' Bottom (horizontal) scrollbar is present. Its size depends on
3437 the longest visible line, or on the cursor line if the 'h'
3438 flag is included. |gui-horiz-scroll|
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003439 *'go-h'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003440 'h' Limit horizontal scrollbar size to the length of the cursor
3441 line. Reduces computations. |gui-horiz-scroll|
3442
3443 And yes, you may even have scrollbars on the left AND the right if
3444 you really want to :-). See |gui-scrollbars| for more information.
3445
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003446 *'go-v'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003447 'v' Use a vertical button layout for dialogs. When not included,
3448 a horizontal layout is preferred, but when it doesn't fit a
3449 vertical layout is used anyway.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003450 *'go-p'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003451 'p' Use Pointer callbacks for X11 GUI. This is required for some
3452 window managers. If the cursor is not blinking or hollow at
3453 the right moment, try adding this flag. This must be done
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00003454 before starting the GUI. Set it in your |gvimrc|. Adding or
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003455 removing it after the GUI has started has no effect.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003456 *'go-F'*
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003457 'F' Add a footer. Only for Motif. See |gui-footer|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003458
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003459
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003460 *'guipty'* *'noguipty'*
3461'guipty' boolean (default on)
3462 global
3463 {not in Vi}
3464 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
3465 Only in the GUI: If on, an attempt is made to open a pseudo-tty for
3466 I/O to/from shell commands. See |gui-pty|.
3467
Bram Moolenaar5c8837f2006-02-25 21:52:33 +00003468 *'guitablabel'* *'gtl'*
3469'guitablabel' 'gtl' string (default empty)
3470 global
3471 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00003472 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled and
3473 with the +windows feature}
Bram Moolenaar5c8837f2006-02-25 21:52:33 +00003474 When nonempty describes the text to use in a label of the GUI tab
Bram Moolenaard68071d2006-05-02 22:08:30 +00003475 pages line. When empty and when the result is empty Vim will use a
3476 default label. See |setting-guitablabel| for more info.
Bram Moolenaar5c8837f2006-02-25 21:52:33 +00003477
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00003478 The format of this option is like that of 'statusline'.
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00003479 'guitabtooltip' is used for the tooltip, see below.
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00003480
Bram Moolenaar5c8837f2006-02-25 21:52:33 +00003481 Only used when the GUI tab pages line is displayed. 'e' must be
3482 present in 'guioptions'. For the non-GUI tab pages line 'tabline' is
3483 used.
3484
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00003485 *'guitabtooltip'* *'gtt'*
3486'guitabtooltip' 'gtt' string (default empty)
3487 global
3488 {not in Vi}
3489 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled and
3490 with the +windows feature}
3491 When nonempty describes the text to use in a tooltip for the GUI tab
3492 pages line. When empty Vim will use a default tooltip.
3493 This option is otherwise just like 'guitablabel' above.
3494
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00003495
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003496 *'helpfile'* *'hf'*
3497'helpfile' 'hf' string (default (MSDOS) "$VIMRUNTIME\doc\help.txt"
3498 (others) "$VIMRUNTIME/doc/help.txt")
3499 global
3500 {not in Vi}
3501 Name of the main help file. All distributed help files should be
3502 placed together in one directory. Additionally, all "doc" directories
3503 in 'runtimepath' will be used.
3504 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. For example:
3505 "$VIMRUNTIME/doc/help.txt". If $VIMRUNTIME is not set, $VIM is also
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003506 tried. Also see |$VIMRUNTIME| and |option-backslash| about including
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003507 spaces and backslashes.
3508 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3509 security reasons.
3510
3511 *'helpheight'* *'hh'*
3512'helpheight' 'hh' number (default 20)
3513 global
3514 {not in Vi}
3515 {not available when compiled without the +windows
3516 feature}
3517 Minimal initial height of the help window when it is opened with the
3518 ":help" command. The initial height of the help window is half of the
3519 current window, or (when the 'ea' option is on) the same as other
3520 windows. When the height is less than 'helpheight', the height is
3521 set to 'helpheight'. Set to zero to disable.
3522
3523 *'helplang'* *'hlg'*
3524'helplang' 'hlg' string (default: messages language or empty)
3525 global
3526 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_lang|
3527 feature}
3528 {not in Vi}
3529 Comma separated list of languages. Vim will use the first language
3530 for which the desired help can be found. The English help will always
3531 be used as a last resort. You can add "en" to prefer English over
3532 another language, but that will only find tags that exist in that
3533 language and not in the English help.
3534 Example: >
3535 :set helplang=de,it
3536< This will first search German, then Italian and finally English help
3537 files.
3538 When using |CTRL-]| and ":help!" in a non-English help file Vim will
3539 try to find the tag in the current language before using this option.
3540 See |help-translated|.
3541
3542 *'hidden'* *'hid'* *'nohidden'* *'nohid'*
3543'hidden' 'hid' boolean (default off)
3544 global
3545 {not in Vi}
3546 When off a buffer is unloaded when it is |abandon|ed. When on a
3547 buffer becomes hidden when it is |abandon|ed. If the buffer is still
3548 displayed in another window, it does not become hidden, of course.
3549 The commands that move through the buffer list sometimes make a buffer
3550 hidden although the 'hidden' option is off: When the buffer is
3551 modified, 'autowrite' is off or writing is not possible, and the '!'
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003552 flag was used. See also |windows.txt|.
Bram Moolenaarcfbc5ee2004-07-02 15:38:35 +00003553 To only make one buffer hidden use the 'bufhidden' option.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003554 This option is set for one command with ":hide {command}" |:hide|.
3555 WARNING: It's easy to forget that you have changes in hidden buffers.
3556 Think twice when using ":q!" or ":qa!".
3557
3558 *'highlight'* *'hl'*
3559'highlight' 'hl' string (default (as a single string):
3560 "8:SpecialKey,@:NonText,d:Directory,
3561 e:ErrorMsg,i:IncSearch,l:Search,m:MoreMsg,
3562 M:ModeMsg,n:LineNr,r:Question,
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00003563 s:StatusLine,S:StatusLineNC,c:VertSplit,
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003564 t:Title,v:Visual,w:WarningMsg,W:WildMenu,
3565 f:Folded,F:FoldColumn,A:DiffAdd,
3566 C:DiffChange,D:DiffDelete,T:DiffText,
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00003567 >:SignColumn,B:SpellBad,P:SpellCap,
Bram Moolenaar1c7715d2005-10-03 22:02:18 +00003568 R:SpellRare,L:SpellLocal,
3569 +:Pmenu,=:PmenuSel,
3570 x:PmenuSbar,X:PmenuThumb")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003571 global
3572 {not in Vi}
3573 This option can be used to set highlighting mode for various
3574 occasions. It is a comma separated list of character pairs. The
3575 first character in a pair gives the occasion, the second the mode to
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003576 use for that occasion. The occasions are:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003577 |hl-SpecialKey| 8 Meta and special keys listed with ":map"
3578 |hl-NonText| @ '~' and '@' at the end of the window and
3579 characters from 'showbreak'
3580 |hl-Directory| d directories in CTRL-D listing and other special
3581 things in listings
3582 |hl-ErrorMsg| e error messages
3583 h (obsolete, ignored)
3584 |hl-IncSearch| i 'incsearch' highlighting
3585 |hl-Search| l last search pattern highlighting (see 'hlsearch')
3586 |hl-MoreMsg| m |more-prompt|
3587 |hl-ModeMsg| M Mode (e.g., "-- INSERT --")
3588 |hl-LineNr| n line number for ":number" and ":#" commands
3589 |hl-Question| r |hit-enter| prompt and yes/no questions
3590 |hl-StatusLine| s status line of current window |status-line|
3591 |hl-StatusLineNC| S status lines of not-current windows
3592 |hl-Title| t Titles for output from ":set all", ":autocmd" etc.
3593 |hl-VertSplit| c column used to separate vertically split windows
3594 |hl-Visual| v Visual mode
3595 |hl-VisualNOS| V Visual mode when Vim does is "Not Owning the
3596 Selection" Only X11 Gui's |gui-x11| and
3597 |xterm-clipboard|.
3598 |hl-WarningMsg| w warning messages
3599 |hl-WildMenu| W wildcard matches displayed for 'wildmenu'
3600 |hl-Folded| f line used for closed folds
3601 |hl-FoldColumn| F 'foldcolumn'
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00003602 |hl-DiffAdd| A added line in diff mode
3603 |hl-DiffChange| C changed line in diff mode
3604 |hl-DiffDelete| D deleted line in diff mode
3605 |hl-DiffText| T inserted text in diff mode
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003606 |hl-SignColumn| > column used for |signs|
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00003607 |hl-SpellBad| B misspelled word |spell|
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00003608 |hl-SpellCap| P word that should start with capital|spell|
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00003609 |hl-SpellRare| R rare word |spell|
3610 |hl-SpellLocal| L word from other region |spell|
Bram Moolenaar1c7715d2005-10-03 22:02:18 +00003611 |hl-Pmenu| + popup menu normal line
3612 |hl-PmenuSel| = popup menu normal line
3613 |hl-PmenuSbar| x popup menu scrollbar
3614 |hl-PmenuThumb| X popup menu scrollbar thumb
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003615
3616 The display modes are:
3617 r reverse (termcap entry "mr" and "me")
3618 i italic (termcap entry "ZH" and "ZR")
3619 b bold (termcap entry "md" and "me")
3620 s standout (termcap entry "so" and "se")
3621 u underline (termcap entry "us" and "ue")
Bram Moolenaare2cc9702005-03-15 22:43:58 +00003622 c undercurl (termcap entry "Cs" and "Ce")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003623 n no highlighting
3624 - no highlighting
3625 : use a highlight group
3626 The default is used for occasions that are not included.
3627 If you want to change what the display modes do, see |dos-colors|
3628 for an example.
3629 When using the ':' display mode, this must be followed by the name of
3630 a highlight group. A highlight group can be used to define any type
3631 of highlighting, including using color. See |:highlight| on how to
3632 define one. The default uses a different group for each occasion.
3633 See |highlight-default| for the default highlight groups.
3634
3635 *'hlsearch'* *'hls'* *'nohlsearch'* *'nohls'*
3636'hlsearch' 'hls' boolean (default off)
3637 global
3638 {not in Vi}
3639 {not available when compiled without the
3640 |+extra_search| feature}
3641 When there is a previous search pattern, highlight all its matches.
3642 The type of highlighting used can be set with the 'l' occasion in the
3643 'highlight' option. This uses the "Search" highlight group by
3644 default. Note that only the matching text is highlighted, any offsets
3645 are not applied.
3646 See also: 'incsearch' and |:match|.
3647 When you get bored looking at the highlighted matches, you can turn it
3648 off with |:nohlsearch|. As soon as you use a search command, the
3649 highlighting comes back.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00003650 'redrawtime' specifies the maximum time spent on finding matches.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003651 When the search pattern can match an end-of-line, Vim will try to
3652 highlight all of the matched text. However, this depends on where the
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003653 search starts. This will be the first line in the window or the first
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003654 line below a closed fold. A match in a previous line which is not
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00003655 drawn may not continue in a newly drawn line.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003656 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3657
3658 *'history'* *'hi'*
3659'history' 'hi' number (Vim default: 20, Vi default: 0)
3660 global
3661 {not in Vi}
3662 A history of ":" commands, and a history of previous search patterns
3663 are remembered. This option decides how many entries may be stored in
3664 each of these histories (see |cmdline-editing|).
3665 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3666 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3667
3668 *'hkmap'* *'hk'* *'nohkmap'* *'nohk'*
3669'hkmap' 'hk' boolean (default off)
3670 global
3671 {not in Vi}
3672 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3673 feature}
3674 When on, the keyboard is mapped for the Hebrew character set.
3675 Normally you would set 'allowrevins' and use CTRL-_ in insert mode to
3676 toggle this option. See |rileft.txt|.
3677 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3678
3679 *'hkmapp'* *'hkp'* *'nohkmapp'* *'nohkp'*
3680'hkmapp' 'hkp' boolean (default off)
3681 global
3682 {not in Vi}
3683 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3684 feature}
3685 When on, phonetic keyboard mapping is used. 'hkmap' must also be on.
3686 This is useful if you have a non-Hebrew keyboard.
3687 See |rileft.txt|.
3688 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3689
3690 *'icon'* *'noicon'*
3691'icon' boolean (default off, on when title can be restored)
3692 global
3693 {not in Vi}
3694 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
3695 feature}
3696 When on, the icon text of the window will be set to the value of
3697 'iconstring' (if it is not empty), or to the name of the file
3698 currently being edited. Only the last part of the name is used.
3699 Overridden by the 'iconstring' option.
3700 Only works if the terminal supports setting window icons (currently
3701 only X11 GUI and terminals with a non-empty 't_IS' option - these are
3702 Unix xterm and iris-ansi by default, where 't_IS' is taken from the
3703 builtin termcap).
3704 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original icon will be
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00003705 restored if possible |X11|. See |X11-icon| for changing the icon on
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003706 X11.
3707
3708 *'iconstring'*
3709'iconstring' string (default "")
3710 global
3711 {not in Vi}
3712 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
3713 feature}
3714 When this option is not empty, it will be used for the icon text of
3715 the window. This happens only when the 'icon' option is on.
3716 Only works if the terminal supports setting window icon text
3717 (currently only X11 GUI and terminals with a non-empty 't_IS' option).
3718 Does not work for MS Windows.
3719 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original icon will be
3720 restored if possible |X11|.
3721 When this option contains printf-style '%' items, they will be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003722 expanded according to the rules used for 'statusline'. See
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003723 'titlestring' for example settings.
3724 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| feature}
3725
3726 *'ignorecase'* *'ic'* *'noignorecase'* *'noic'*
3727'ignorecase' 'ic' boolean (default off)
3728 global
3729 Ignore case in search patterns. Also used when searching in the tags
3730 file.
3731 Also see 'smartcase'.
3732 Can be overruled by using "\c" or "\C" in the pattern, see
3733 |/ignorecase|.
3734
3735 *'imactivatekey'* *'imak'*
3736'imactivatekey' 'imak' string (default "")
3737 global
3738 {not in Vi}
3739 {only available when compiled with |+xim| and
3740 |+GUI_GTK|}
3741 Specifies the key that your Input Method in X-Windows uses for
3742 activation. When this is specified correctly, vim can fully control
3743 IM with 'imcmdline', 'iminsert' and 'imsearch'.
3744 You can't use this option to change the activation key, the option
3745 tells Vim what the key is.
3746 Format:
3747 [MODIFIER_FLAG-]KEY_STRING
3748
3749 These characters can be used for MODIFIER_FLAG (case is ignored):
3750 S Shift key
3751 L Lock key
3752 C Control key
3753 1 Mod1 key
3754 2 Mod2 key
3755 3 Mod3 key
3756 4 Mod4 key
3757 5 Mod5 key
3758 Combinations are allowed, for example "S-C-space" or "SC-space" are
3759 both shift+ctrl+space.
3760 See <X11/keysymdef.h> and XStringToKeysym for KEY_STRING.
3761
3762 Example: >
3763 :set imactivatekey=S-space
3764< "S-space" means shift+space. This is the activation key for kinput2 +
3765 canna (Japanese), and ami (Korean).
3766
3767 *'imcmdline'* *'imc'* *'noimcmdline'* *'noimc'*
3768'imcmdline' 'imc' boolean (default off)
3769 global
3770 {not in Vi}
3771 {only available when compiled with the |+xim|
3772 |+multi_byte_ime| or |global-ime| feature}
3773 When set the Input Method is always on when starting to edit a command
3774 line, unless entering a search pattern (see 'imsearch' for that).
3775 Setting this option is useful when your input method allows entering
3776 English characters directly, e.g., when it's used to type accented
3777 characters with dead keys.
3778
3779 *'imdisable'* *'imd'* *'nodisable'* *'noimd'*
3780'imdisable' 'imd' boolean (default off, on for some systems (SGI))
3781 global
3782 {not in Vi}
3783 {only available when compiled with the |+xim|
3784 |+multi_byte_ime| or |global-ime| feature}
3785 When set the Input Method is never used. This is useful to disable
3786 the IM when it doesn't work properly.
3787 Currently this option is on by default for SGI/IRIX machines. This
3788 may change in later releases.
3789
3790 *'iminsert'* *'imi'*
3791'iminsert' 'imi' number (default 0, 2 when an input method is supported)
3792 local to buffer
3793 {not in Vi}
3794 Specifies whether :lmap or an Input Method (IM) is to be used in
3795 Insert mode. Valid values:
3796 0 :lmap is off and IM is off
3797 1 :lmap is ON and IM is off
3798 2 :lmap is off and IM is ON
3799 2 is available only when compiled with the |+multi_byte_ime|, |+xim|
3800 or |global-ime|.
3801 To always reset the option to zero when leaving Insert mode with <Esc>
3802 this can be used: >
3803 :inoremap <ESC> <ESC>:set iminsert=0<CR>
3804< This makes :lmap and IM turn off automatically when leaving Insert
3805 mode.
3806 Note that this option changes when using CTRL-^ in Insert mode
3807 |i_CTRL-^|.
3808 The value is set to 1 when setting 'keymap' to a valid keymap name.
3809 It is also used for the argument of commands like "r" and "f".
3810 The value 0 may not work correctly with Athena and Motif with some XIM
3811 methods. Use 'imdisable' to disable XIM then.
3812
3813 *'imsearch'* *'ims'*
3814'imsearch' 'ims' number (default 0, 2 when an input method is supported)
3815 local to buffer
3816 {not in Vi}
3817 Specifies whether :lmap or an Input Method (IM) is to be used when
3818 entering a search pattern. Valid values:
3819 -1 the value of 'iminsert' is used, makes it look like
3820 'iminsert' is also used when typing a search pattern
3821 0 :lmap is off and IM is off
3822 1 :lmap is ON and IM is off
3823 2 :lmap is off and IM is ON
3824 Note that this option changes when using CTRL-^ in Command-line mode
3825 |c_CTRL-^|.
3826 The value is set to 1 when it is not -1 and setting the 'keymap'
3827 option to a valid keymap name.
3828 The value 0 may not work correctly with Athena and Motif with some XIM
3829 methods. Use 'imdisable' to disable XIM then.
3830
3831 *'include'* *'inc'*
3832'include' 'inc' string (default "^\s*#\s*include")
3833 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3834 {not in Vi}
3835 {not available when compiled without the
3836 |+find_in_path| feature}
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003837 Pattern to be used to find an include command. It is a search
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003838 pattern, just like for the "/" command (See |pattern|). The default
3839 value is for C programs. This option is used for the commands "[i",
Bram Moolenaar1e015462005-09-25 22:16:38 +00003840 "]I", "[d", etc.
3841 Normally the 'isfname' option is used to recognize the file name that
Bram Moolenaar482aaeb2005-09-29 18:26:07 +00003842 comes after the matched pattern. But if "\zs" appears in the pattern
3843 then the text matched from "\zs" to the end, or until "\ze" if it
3844 appears, is used as the file name. Use this to include characters
3845 that are not in 'isfname', such as a space. You can then use
3846 'includeexpr' to process the matched text.
Bram Moolenaar1e015462005-09-25 22:16:38 +00003847 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003848
3849 *'includeexpr'* *'inex'*
3850'includeexpr' 'inex' string (default "")
3851 local to buffer
3852 {not in Vi}
3853 {not available when compiled without the
3854 |+find_in_path| or |+eval| feature}
3855 Expression to be used to transform the string found with the 'include'
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003856 option to a file name. Mostly useful to change "." to "/" for Java: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003857 :set includeexpr=substitute(v:fname,'\\.','/','g')
3858< The "v:fname" variable will be set to the file name that was detected.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00003859
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003860 Also used for the |gf| command if an unmodified file name can't be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003861 found. Allows doing "gf" on the name after an 'include' statement.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003862 Also used for |<cfile>|.
3863
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00003864 The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
3865 |sandbox-option|.
3866
3867 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
3868 evaluating 'includeexpr' |textlock|.
3869
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003870 *'incsearch'* *'is'* *'noincsearch'* *'nois'*
3871'incsearch' 'is' boolean (default off)
3872 global
3873 {not in Vi}
3874 {not available when compiled without the
3875 |+extra_search| feature}
Bram Moolenaar21cf8232004-07-16 20:18:37 +00003876 While typing a search command, show where the pattern, as it was typed
3877 so far, matches. The matched string is highlighted. If the pattern
3878 is invalid or not found, nothing is shown. The screen will be updated
3879 often, this is only useful on fast terminals.
3880 Note that the match will be shown, but the cursor will return to its
3881 original position when no match is found and when pressing <Esc>. You
3882 still need to finish the search command with <Enter> to move the
3883 cursor to the match.
Bram Moolenaar91a4e822008-01-19 14:59:58 +00003884 When compiled with the |+reltime| feature Vim only searches for about
3885 half a second. With a complicated pattern and/or a lot of text the
3886 match may not be found. This is to avoid that Vim hangs while you
3887 are typing the pattern.
Bram Moolenaar21cf8232004-07-16 20:18:37 +00003888 The highlighting can be set with the 'i' flag in 'highlight'.
3889 See also: 'hlsearch'.
Bram Moolenaarefd2bf12006-03-16 21:41:35 +00003890 CTRL-L can be used to add one character from after the current match
3891 to the command line.
3892 CTRL-R CTRL-W can be used to add the word at the end of the current
3893 match, excluding the characters that were already typed.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003894 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3895
3896 *'indentexpr'* *'inde'*
3897'indentexpr' 'inde' string (default "")
3898 local to buffer
3899 {not in Vi}
3900 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
3901 or |+eval| features}
3902 Expression which is evaluated to obtain the proper indent for a line.
3903 It is used when a new line is created, for the |=| operator and
3904 in Insert mode as specified with the 'indentkeys' option.
3905 When this option is not empty, it overrules the 'cindent' and
3906 'smartindent' indenting.
3907 When 'paste' is set this option is not used for indenting.
3908 The expression is evaluated with |v:lnum| set to the line number for
Bram Moolenaar482aaeb2005-09-29 18:26:07 +00003909 which the indent is to be computed. The cursor is also in this line
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003910 when the expression is evaluated (but it may be moved around).
3911 The expression must return the number of spaces worth of indent. It
3912 can return "-1" to keep the current indent (this means 'autoindent' is
3913 used for the indent).
3914 Functions useful for computing the indent are |indent()|, |cindent()|
3915 and |lispindent()|.
3916 The evaluation of the expression must not have side effects! It must
3917 not change the text, jump to another window, etc. Afterwards the
3918 cursor position is always restored, thus the cursor may be moved.
3919 Normally this option would be set to call a function: >
3920 :set indentexpr=GetMyIndent()
3921< Error messages will be suppressed, unless the 'debug' option contains
3922 "msg".
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00003923 See |indent-expression|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003924 NOTE: This option is made empty when 'compatible' is set.
3925
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00003926 The expression may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
3927 |sandbox-option|.
3928
3929 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
3930 evaluating 'indentexpr' |textlock|.
3931
3932
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003933 *'indentkeys'* *'indk'*
3934'indentkeys' 'indk' string (default "0{,0},:,0#,!^F,o,O,e")
3935 local to buffer
3936 {not in Vi}
3937 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
3938 feature}
3939 A list of keys that, when typed in Insert mode, cause reindenting of
3940 the current line. Only happens if 'indentexpr' isn't empty.
3941 The format is identical to 'cinkeys', see |indentkeys-format|.
3942 See |C-indenting| and |indent-expression|.
3943
3944 *'infercase'* *'inf'* *'noinfercase'* *'noinf'*
3945'infercase' 'inf' boolean (default off)
3946 local to buffer
3947 {not in Vi}
3948 When doing keyword completion in insert mode |ins-completion|, and
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00003949 'ignorecase' is also on, the case of the match is adjusted depending
3950 on the typed text. If the typed text contains a lowercase letter
3951 where the match has an upper case letter, the completed part is made
3952 lowercase. If the typed text has no lowercase letters and the match
3953 has a lowercase letter where the typed text has an uppercase letter,
3954 and there is a letter before it, the completed part is made uppercase.
3955 With 'noinfercase' the match is used as-is.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003956
3957 *'insertmode'* *'im'* *'noinsertmode'* *'noim'*
3958'insertmode' 'im' boolean (default off)
3959 global
3960 {not in Vi}
3961 Makes Vim work in a way that Insert mode is the default mode. Useful
3962 if you want to use Vim as a modeless editor. Used for |evim|.
3963 These Insert mode commands will be useful:
3964 - Use the cursor keys to move around.
3965 - Use CTRL-O to execute one Normal mode command |i_CTRL-O|). When
3966 this is a mapping, it is executed as if 'insertmode' was off.
3967 Normal mode remains active until the mapping is finished.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003968 - Use CTRL-L to execute a number of Normal mode commands, then use
Bram Moolenaar488c6512005-08-11 20:09:58 +00003969 <Esc> to get back to Insert mode. Note that CTRL-L moves the cursor
3970 left, like <Esc> does when 'insertmode' isn't set. |i_CTRL-L|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003971
3972 These items change when 'insertmode' is set:
3973 - when starting to edit of a file, Vim goes to Insert mode.
3974 - <Esc> in Insert mode is a no-op and beeps.
3975 - <Esc> in Normal mode makes Vim go to Insert mode.
3976 - CTRL-L in Insert mode is a command, it is not inserted.
3977 - CTRL-Z in Insert mode suspends Vim, see |CTRL-Z|. *i_CTRL-Z*
3978 However, when <Esc> is used inside a mapping, it behaves like
3979 'insertmode' was not set. This was done to be able to use the same
3980 mappings with 'insertmode' set or not set.
3981 When executing commands with |:normal| 'insertmode' is not used.
3982
3983 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3984
3985 *'isfname'* *'isf'*
3986'isfname' 'isf' string (default for MS-DOS, Win32 and OS/2:
3987 "@,48-57,/,\,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,{,},[,],:,@-@,!,~,="
3988 for AMIGA: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,$,:"
3989 for VMS: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,<,>,[,],:,;,~"
3990 for OS/390: "@,240-249,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,~,="
3991 otherwise: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,~,=")
3992 global
3993 {not in Vi}
3994 The characters specified by this option are included in file names and
3995 path names. Filenames are used for commands like "gf", "[i" and in
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003996 the tags file. It is also used for "\f" in a |pattern|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003997 Multi-byte characters 256 and above are always included, only the
3998 characters up to 255 are specified with this option.
3999 For UTF-8 the characters 0xa0 to 0xff are included as well.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00004000 Think twice before adding white space to this option. Although a
4001 space may appear inside a file name, the effect will be that Vim
4002 doesn't know where a file name starts or ends when doing completion.
4003 It most likely works better without a space in 'isfname'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004004
4005 Note that on systems using a backslash as path separator, Vim tries to
4006 do its best to make it work as you would expect. That is a bit
4007 tricky, since Vi originally used the backslash to escape special
4008 characters. Vim will not remove a backslash in front of a normal file
4009 name character on these systems, but it will on Unix and alikes. The
4010 '&' and '^' are not included by default, because these are special for
4011 cmd.exe.
4012
4013 The format of this option is a list of parts, separated with commas.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004014 Each part can be a single character number or a range. A range is two
4015 character numbers with '-' in between. A character number can be a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004016 decimal number between 0 and 255 or the ASCII character itself (does
4017 not work for digits). Example:
4018 "_,-,128-140,#-43" (include '_' and '-' and the range
4019 128 to 140 and '#' to 43)
4020 If a part starts with '^', the following character number or range
4021 will be excluded from the option. The option is interpreted from left
4022 to right. Put the excluded character after the range where it is
4023 included. To include '^' itself use it as the last character of the
4024 option or the end of a range. Example:
4025 "^a-z,#,^" (exclude 'a' to 'z', include '#' and '^')
4026 If the character is '@', all characters where isalpha() returns TRUE
4027 are included. Normally these are the characters a to z and A to Z,
4028 plus accented characters. To include '@' itself use "@-@". Examples:
4029 "@,^a-z" All alphabetic characters, excluding lower
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00004030 case ASCII letters.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004031 "a-z,A-Z,@-@" All letters plus the '@' character.
4032 A comma can be included by using it where a character number is
4033 expected. Example:
4034 "48-57,,,_" Digits, comma and underscore.
4035 A comma can be excluded by prepending a '^'. Example:
4036 " -~,^,,9" All characters from space to '~', excluding
4037 comma, plus <Tab>.
4038 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
4039
4040 *'isident'* *'isi'*
4041'isident' 'isi' string (default for MS-DOS, Win32 and OS/2:
4042 "@,48-57,_,128-167,224-235"
4043 otherwise: "@,48-57,_,192-255")
4044 global
4045 {not in Vi}
4046 The characters given by this option are included in identifiers.
4047 Identifiers are used in recognizing environment variables and after a
4048 match of the 'define' option. It is also used for "\i" in a
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00004049 |pattern|. See 'isfname' for a description of the format of this
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004050 option.
4051 Careful: If you change this option, it might break expanding
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004052 environment variables. E.g., when '/' is included and Vim tries to
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004053 expand "$HOME/.viminfo". Maybe you should change 'iskeyword' instead.
4054
4055 *'iskeyword'* *'isk'*
4056'iskeyword' 'isk' string (Vim default for MS-DOS and Win32:
4057 "@,48-57,_,128-167,224-235"
4058 otherwise: "@,48-57,_,192-255"
4059 Vi default: "@,48-57,_")
4060 local to buffer
4061 {not in Vi}
4062 Keywords are used in searching and recognizing with many commands:
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004063 "w", "*", "[i", etc. It is also used for "\k" in a |pattern|. See
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004064 'isfname' for a description of the format of this option. For C
4065 programs you could use "a-z,A-Z,48-57,_,.,-,>".
4066 For a help file it is set to all non-blank printable characters except
4067 '*', '"' and '|' (so that CTRL-] on a command finds the help for that
4068 command).
4069 When the 'lisp' option is on the '-' character is always included.
4070 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
4071 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
4072
4073 *'isprint'* *'isp'*
4074'isprint' 'isp' string (default for MS-DOS, Win32, OS/2 and Macintosh:
4075 "@,~-255"; otherwise: "@,161-255")
4076 global
4077 {not in Vi}
4078 The characters given by this option are displayed directly on the
4079 screen. It is also used for "\p" in a |pattern|. The characters from
4080 space (ASCII 32) to '~' (ASCII 126) are always displayed directly,
4081 even when they are not included in 'isprint' or excluded. See
4082 'isfname' for a description of the format of this option.
4083
4084 Non-printable characters are displayed with two characters:
4085 0 - 31 "^@" - "^_"
4086 32 - 126 always single characters
4087 127 "^?"
4088 128 - 159 "~@" - "~_"
4089 160 - 254 "| " - "|~"
4090 255 "~?"
4091 When 'encoding' is a Unicode one, illegal bytes from 128 to 255 are
4092 displayed as <xx>, with the hexadecimal value of the byte.
4093 When 'display' contains "uhex" all unprintable characters are
4094 displayed as <xx>.
4095 The NonText highlighting will be used for unprintable characters.
4096 |hl-NonText|
4097
4098 Multi-byte characters 256 and above are always included, only the
4099 characters up to 255 are specified with this option. When a character
4100 is printable but it is not available in the current font, a
4101 replacement character will be shown.
4102 Unprintable and zero-width Unicode characters are displayed as <xxxx>.
4103 There is no option to specify these characters.
4104
4105 *'joinspaces'* *'js'* *'nojoinspaces'* *'nojs'*
4106'joinspaces' 'js' boolean (default on)
4107 global
4108 {not in Vi}
4109 Insert two spaces after a '.', '?' and '!' with a join command.
4110 When 'cpoptions' includes the 'j' flag, only do this after a '.'.
4111 Otherwise only one space is inserted.
4112 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set.
4113
4114 *'key'*
4115'key' string (default "")
4116 local to buffer
4117 {not in Vi}
4118 The key that is used for encrypting and decrypting the current buffer.
4119 See |encryption|.
4120 Careful: Do not set the key value by hand, someone might see the typed
4121 key. Use the |:X| command. But you can make 'key' empty: >
4122 :set key=
4123< It is not possible to get the value of this option with ":set key" or
4124 "echo &key". This is to avoid showing it to someone who shouldn't
4125 know. It also means you cannot see it yourself once you have set it,
4126 be careful not to make a typing error!
4127
4128 *'keymap'* *'kmp'* *E544*
4129'keymap' 'kmp' string (default "")
4130 local to buffer
4131 {not in Vi}
4132 {only available when compiled with the |+keymap|
4133 feature}
4134 Name of a keyboard mapping. See |mbyte-keymap|.
4135 Setting this option to a valid keymap name has the side effect of
4136 setting 'iminsert' to one, so that the keymap becomes effective.
4137 'imsearch' is also set to one, unless it was -1
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00004138 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004139
4140 *'keymodel'* *'km'*
4141'keymodel' 'km' string (default "")
4142 global
4143 {not in Vi}
4144 List of comma separated words, which enable special things that keys
4145 can do. These values can be used:
4146 startsel Using a shifted special key starts selection (either
4147 Select mode or Visual mode, depending on "key" being
4148 present in 'selectmode').
4149 stopsel Using a not-shifted special key stops selection.
4150 Special keys in this context are the cursor keys, <End>, <Home>,
4151 <PageUp> and <PageDown>.
4152 The 'keymodel' option is set by the |:behave| command.
4153
4154 *'keywordprg'* *'kp'*
4155'keywordprg' 'kp' string (default "man" or "man -s", DOS: ":help",
4156 OS/2: "view /", VMS: "help")
4157 global or local to buffer |global-local|
4158 {not in Vi}
4159 Program to use for the |K| command. Environment variables are
4160 expanded |:set_env|. ":help" may be used to access the Vim internal
4161 help. (Note that previously setting the global option to the empty
4162 value did this, which is now deprecated.)
4163 When "man" is used, Vim will automatically translate a count for the
4164 "K" command to a section number. Also for "man -s", in which case the
4165 "-s" is removed when there is no count.
4166 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
4167 Example: >
4168 :set keywordprg=man\ -s
4169< This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
4170 security reasons.
4171
4172 *'langmap'* *'lmap'* *E357* *E358*
4173'langmap' 'lmap' string (default "")
4174 global
4175 {not in Vi}
4176 {only available when compiled with the |+langmap|
4177 feature}
4178 This option allows switching your keyboard into a special language
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004179 mode. When you are typing text in Insert mode the characters are
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004180 inserted directly. When in command mode the 'langmap' option takes
4181 care of translating these special characters to the original meaning
4182 of the key. This means you don't have to change the keyboard mode to
4183 be able to execute Normal mode commands.
4184 This is the opposite of the 'keymap' option, where characters are
4185 mapped in Insert mode.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004186
Bram Moolenaarfd2ac762006-03-01 22:09:21 +00004187 Example (for Greek, in UTF-8): *greek* >
4188 :set langmap=ΑA,ΒB,ΨC,ΔD,ΕE,ΦF,ΓG,ΗH,ΙI,ΞJ,ΚK,ΛL,ΜM,ΝN,ΟO,ΠP,QQ,ΡR,ΣS,ΤT,ΘU,ΩV,WW,ΧX,ΥY,ΖZ,αa,βb,ψc,δd,εe,φf,γg,ηh,ιi,ξj,κk,λl,μm,νn,οo,πp,qq,ρr,σs,τt,θu,ωv,ςw,χx,υy,ζz
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004189< Example (exchanges meaning of z and y for commands): >
4190 :set langmap=zy,yz,ZY,YZ
4191<
4192 The 'langmap' option is a list of parts, separated with commas. Each
4193 part can be in one of two forms:
4194 1. A list of pairs. Each pair is a "from" character immediately
4195 followed by the "to" character. Examples: "aA", "aAbBcC".
4196 2. A list of "from" characters, a semi-colon and a list of "to"
4197 characters. Example: "abc;ABC"
4198 Example: "aA,fgh;FGH,cCdDeE"
4199 Special characters need to be preceded with a backslash. These are
4200 ";", ',' and backslash itself.
4201
4202 This will allow you to activate vim actions without having to switch
4203 back and forth between the languages. Your language characters will
4204 be understood as normal vim English characters (according to the
4205 langmap mappings) in the following cases:
4206 o Normal/Visual mode (commands, buffer/register names, user mappings)
4207 o Insert/Replace Mode: Register names after CTRL-R
4208 o Insert/Replace Mode: Mappings
4209 Characters entered in Command-line mode will NOT be affected by
4210 this option. Note that this option can be changed at any time
4211 allowing to switch between mappings for different languages/encodings.
4212 Use a mapping to avoid having to type it each time!
4213
4214 *'langmenu'* *'lm'*
4215'langmenu' 'lm' string (default "")
4216 global
4217 {not in Vi}
4218 {only available when compiled with the |+menu| and
4219 |+multi_lang| features}
4220 Language to use for menu translation. Tells which file is loaded
4221 from the "lang" directory in 'runtimepath': >
4222 "lang/menu_" . &langmenu . ".vim"
4223< (without the spaces). For example, to always use the Dutch menus, no
4224 matter what $LANG is set to: >
4225 :set langmenu=nl_NL.ISO_8859-1
4226< When 'langmenu' is empty, |v:lang| is used.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00004227 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004228 If your $LANG is set to a non-English language but you do want to use
4229 the English menus: >
4230 :set langmenu=none
4231< This option must be set before loading menus, switching on filetype
4232 detection or syntax highlighting. Once the menus are defined setting
4233 this option has no effect. But you could do this: >
4234 :source $VIMRUNTIME/delmenu.vim
4235 :set langmenu=de_DE.ISO_8859-1
4236 :source $VIMRUNTIME/menu.vim
4237< Warning: This deletes all menus that you defined yourself!
4238
4239 *'laststatus'* *'ls'*
4240'laststatus' 'ls' number (default 1)
4241 global
4242 {not in Vi}
4243 The value of this option influences when the last window will have a
4244 status line:
4245 0: never
4246 1: only if there are at least two windows
4247 2: always
4248 The screen looks nicer with a status line if you have several
4249 windows, but it takes another screen line. |status-line|
4250
4251 *'lazyredraw'* *'lz'* *'nolazyredraw'* *'nolz'*
4252'lazyredraw' 'lz' boolean (default off)
4253 global
4254 {not in Vi}
4255 When this option is set, the screen will not be redrawn while
4256 executing macros, registers and other commands that have not been
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004257 typed. Also, updating the window title is postponed. To force an
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004258 update use |:redraw|.
4259
4260 *'linebreak'* *'lbr'* *'nolinebreak'* *'nolbr'*
4261'linebreak' 'lbr' boolean (default off)
4262 local to window
4263 {not in Vi}
4264 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
4265 feature}
4266 If on Vim will wrap long lines at a character in 'breakat' rather
4267 than at the last character that fits on the screen. Unlike
4268 'wrapmargin' and 'textwidth', this does not insert <EOL>s in the file,
4269 it only affects the way the file is displayed, not its contents. The
4270 value of 'showbreak' is used to put in front of wrapped lines.
4271 This option is not used when the 'wrap' option is off or 'list' is on.
4272 Note that <Tab> characters after an <EOL> are mostly not displayed
4273 with the right amount of white space.
4274
4275 *'lines'* *E593*
4276'lines' number (default 24 or terminal height)
4277 global
4278 Number of lines of the Vim window.
4279 Normally you don't need to set this. It is done automatically by the
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00004280 terminal initialization code. Also see |posix-screen-size|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004281 When Vim is running in the GUI or in a resizable window, setting this
4282 option will cause the window size to be changed. When you only want
4283 to use the size for the GUI, put the command in your |gvimrc| file.
4284 Vim limits the number of lines to what fits on the screen. You can
4285 use this command to get the tallest window possible: >
4286 :set lines=999
Bram Moolenaarf4d11452005-12-02 00:46:37 +00004287< Minimum value is 2, maximum value is 1000.
4288 If you get less lines than expected, check the 'guiheadroom' option.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004289 When you set this option and Vim is unable to change the physical
4290 number of lines of the display, the display may be messed up.
4291
4292 *'linespace'* *'lsp'*
4293'linespace' 'lsp' number (default 0, 1 for Win32 GUI)
4294 global
4295 {not in Vi}
4296 {only in the GUI}
4297 Number of pixel lines inserted between characters. Useful if the font
4298 uses the full character cell height, making lines touch each other.
4299 When non-zero there is room for underlining.
Bram Moolenaarbc7aa852005-03-06 23:38:09 +00004300 With some fonts there can be too much room between lines (to have
4301 space for ascents and descents). Then it makes sense to set
4302 'linespace' to a negative value. This may cause display problems
4303 though!
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004304
4305 *'lisp'* *'nolisp'*
4306'lisp' boolean (default off)
4307 local to buffer
4308 {not available when compiled without the |+lispindent|
4309 feature}
4310 Lisp mode: When <Enter> is typed in insert mode set the indent for
4311 the next line to Lisp standards (well, sort of). Also happens with
4312 "cc" or "S". 'autoindent' must also be on for this to work. The 'p'
4313 flag in 'cpoptions' changes the method of indenting: Vi compatible or
4314 better. Also see 'lispwords'.
4315 The '-' character is included in keyword characters. Redefines the
4316 "=" operator to use this same indentation algorithm rather than
4317 calling an external program if 'equalprg' is empty.
4318 This option is not used when 'paste' is set.
4319 {Vi: Does it a little bit differently}
4320
4321 *'lispwords'* *'lw'*
4322'lispwords' 'lw' string (default is very long)
4323 global
4324 {not in Vi}
4325 {not available when compiled without the |+lispindent|
4326 feature}
4327 Comma separated list of words that influence the Lisp indenting.
4328 |'lisp'|
4329
4330 *'list'* *'nolist'*
4331'list' boolean (default off)
4332 local to window
4333 List mode: Show tabs as CTRL-I, show end of line with $. Useful to
4334 see the difference between tabs and spaces and for trailing blanks.
4335 Note that this will also affect formatting (set with 'textwidth' or
4336 'wrapmargin') when 'cpoptions' includes 'L'. See 'listchars' for
4337 changing the way tabs are displayed.
4338
4339 *'listchars'* *'lcs'*
4340'listchars' 'lcs' string (default "eol:$")
4341 global
4342 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004343 Strings to use in 'list' mode. It is a comma separated list of string
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004344 settings.
4345 eol:c Character to show at the end of each line. When
4346 omitted, there is no extra character at the end of the
4347 line.
Bram Moolenaarebcbd022007-05-12 14:28:25 +00004348 tab:xy Two characters to be used to show a tab. The first
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004349 char is used once. The second char is repeated to
Bram Moolenaarebcbd022007-05-12 14:28:25 +00004350 fill the space that the tab normally occupies.
4351 "tab:>-" will show a tab that takes four spaces as
4352 ">---". When omitted, a tab is show as ^I.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004353 trail:c Character to show for trailing spaces. When omitted,
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004354 trailing spaces are blank.
4355 extends:c Character to show in the last column, when 'wrap' is
4356 off and the line continues beyond the right of the
4357 screen.
4358 precedes:c Character to show in the first column, when 'wrap'
4359 is off and there is text preceding the character
4360 visible in the first column.
Bram Moolenaar592e0a22004-07-03 16:05:59 +00004361 nbsp:c Character to show for a non-breakable space (character
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00004362 0xA0, 160). Left blank when omitted.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004363
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004364 The characters ':' and ',' should not be used. UTF-8 characters can
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004365 be used when 'encoding' is "utf-8", otherwise only printable
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00004366 characters are allowed. All characters must be single width.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004367
4368 Examples: >
4369 :set lcs=tab:>-,trail:-
Bram Moolenaarcfbc5ee2004-07-02 15:38:35 +00004370 :set lcs=tab:>-,eol:<,nbsp:%
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004371 :set lcs=extends:>,precedes:<
4372< The "NonText" highlighting will be used for "eol", "extends" and
Bram Moolenaarcfbc5ee2004-07-02 15:38:35 +00004373 "precedes". "SpecialKey" for "nbsp", "tab" and "trail".
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00004374 |hl-NonText| |hl-SpecialKey|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004375
4376 *'lpl'* *'nolpl'* *'loadplugins'* *'noloadplugins'*
4377'loadplugins' 'lpl' boolean (default on)
4378 global
4379 {not in Vi}
4380 When on the plugin scripts are loaded when starting up |load-plugins|.
4381 This option can be reset in your |vimrc| file to disable the loading
4382 of plugins.
4383 Note that using the "-u NONE" and "--noplugin" command line arguments
4384 reset this option. |-u| |--noplugin|
4385
Bram Moolenaarf9393ef2006-04-24 19:47:27 +00004386 *'macatsui'* *'nomacatsui'*
4387'macatsui' boolean (default on)
4388 global
4389 {only available in Mac GUI version}
4390 This is a workaround for when drawing doesn't work properly. When set
4391 and compiled with multi-byte support ATSUI text drawing is used. When
4392 not set ATSUI text drawing is not used. Switch this option off when
4393 you experience drawing problems. In a future version the problems may
4394 be solved and this option becomes obsolete. Therefore use this method
4395 to unset it: >
4396 if exists('&macatsui')
4397 set nomacatsui
4398 endif
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00004399< Another option to check if you have drawing problems is
4400 'termencoding'.
4401
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004402 *'magic'* *'nomagic'*
4403'magic' boolean (default on)
4404 global
4405 Changes the special characters that can be used in search patterns.
4406 See |pattern|.
4407 NOTE: To avoid portability problems with using patterns, always keep
4408 this option at the default "on". Only switch it off when working with
4409 old Vi scripts. In any other situation write patterns that work when
Bram Moolenaar5eb86f92004-07-26 12:53:41 +00004410 'magic' is on. Include "\M" when you want to |/\M|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004411
4412 *'makeef'* *'mef'*
4413'makeef' 'mef' string (default: "")
4414 global
4415 {not in Vi}
4416 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
4417 feature}
4418 Name of the errorfile for the |:make| command (see |:make_makeprg|)
4419 and the |:grep| command.
4420 When it is empty, an internally generated temp file will be used.
4421 When "##" is included, it is replaced by a number to make the name
4422 unique. This makes sure that the ":make" command doesn't overwrite an
4423 existing file.
4424 NOT used for the ":cf" command. See 'errorfile' for that.
4425 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
4426 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
4427 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
4428 security reasons.
4429
4430 *'makeprg'* *'mp'*
4431'makeprg' 'mp' string (default "make", VMS: "MMS")
4432 global or local to buffer |global-local|
4433 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00004434 Program to use for the ":make" command. See |:make_makeprg|.
4435 This option may contain '%' and '#' characters, which are expanded to
4436 the current and alternate file name. |:_%| |:_#|
4437 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash|
4438 about including spaces and backslashes.
4439 Note that a '|' must be escaped twice: once for ":set" and once for
4440 the interpretation of a command. When you use a filter called
4441 "myfilter" do it like this: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004442 :set makeprg=gmake\ \\\|\ myfilter
4443< The placeholder "$*" can be given (even multiple times) to specify
4444 where the arguments will be included, for example: >
4445 :set makeprg=latex\ \\\\nonstopmode\ \\\\input\\{$*}
4446< This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
4447 security reasons.
4448
4449 *'matchpairs'* *'mps'*
4450'matchpairs' 'mps' string (default "(:),{:},[:]")
4451 local to buffer
4452 {not in Vi}
4453 Characters that form pairs. The |%| command jumps from one to the
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00004454 other. Currently only single byte character pairs are allowed, and
4455 they must be different. The characters must be separated by a colon.
4456 The pairs must be separated by a comma. Example for including '<' and
4457 '>' (HTML): >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004458 :set mps+=<:>
4459
4460< A more exotic example, to jump between the '=' and ';' in an
4461 assignment, useful for languages like C and Java: >
4462 :au FileType c,cpp,java set mps+==:;
4463
4464< For a more advanced way of using "%", see the matchit.vim plugin in
4465 the $VIMRUNTIME/macros directory. |add-local-help|
4466
4467 *'matchtime'* *'mat'*
4468'matchtime' 'mat' number (default 5)
4469 global
4470 {not in Vi}{in Nvi}
4471 Tenths of a second to show the matching paren, when 'showmatch' is
4472 set. Note that this is not in milliseconds, like other options that
4473 set a time. This is to be compatible with Nvi.
4474
Bram Moolenaar362e1a32006-03-06 23:29:24 +00004475 *'maxcombine'* *'mco'*
4476'maxcombine' 'mco' number (default 2)
4477 global
4478 {not in Vi}
4479 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
4480 feature}
4481 The maximum number of combining characters supported for displaying.
4482 Only used when 'encoding' is "utf-8".
4483 The default is OK for most languages. Hebrew may require 4.
4484 Maximum value is 6.
4485 Even when this option is set to 2 you can still edit text with more
4486 combining characters, you just can't see them. Use |g8| or |ga|.
4487 See |mbyte-combining|.
4488
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004489 *'maxfuncdepth'* *'mfd'*
4490'maxfuncdepth' 'mfd' number (default 100)
4491 global
4492 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00004493 {not available when compiled without the +eval
4494 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004495 Maximum depth of function calls for user functions. This normally
4496 catches endless recursion. When using a recursive function with
4497 more depth, set 'maxfuncdepth' to a bigger number. But this will use
4498 more memory, there is the danger of failing when memory is exhausted.
4499 See also |:function|.
4500
4501 *'maxmapdepth'* *'mmd'* *E223*
4502'maxmapdepth' 'mmd' number (default 1000)
4503 global
4504 {not in Vi}
4505 Maximum number of times a mapping is done without resulting in a
4506 character to be used. This normally catches endless mappings, like
4507 ":map x y" with ":map y x". It still does not catch ":map g wg",
4508 because the 'w' is used before the next mapping is done. See also
4509 |key-mapping|.
4510
4511 *'maxmem'* *'mm'*
4512'maxmem' 'mm' number (default between 256 to 5120 (system
4513 dependent) or half the amount of memory
4514 available)
4515 global
4516 {not in Vi}
4517 Maximum amount of memory (in Kbyte) to use for one buffer. When this
4518 limit is reached allocating extra memory for a buffer will cause
4519 other memory to be freed. Maximum value 2000000. Use this to work
4520 without a limit. Also see 'maxmemtot'.
4521
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00004522 *'maxmempattern'* *'mmp'*
4523'maxmempattern' 'mmp' number (default 1000)
4524 global
4525 {not in Vi}
4526 Maximum amount of memory (in Kbyte) to use for pattern matching.
4527 Maximum value 2000000. Use this to work without a limit.
4528 *E363*
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00004529 When Vim runs into the limit it gives an error message and mostly
4530 behaves like CTRL-C was typed.
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00004531 Running into the limit often means that the pattern is very
4532 inefficient or too complex. This may already happen with the pattern
4533 "\(.\)*" on a very long line. ".*" works much better.
4534 Vim may run out of memory before hitting the 'maxmempattern' limit.
4535
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004536 *'maxmemtot'* *'mmt'*
4537'maxmemtot' 'mmt' number (default between 2048 and 10240 (system
4538 dependent) or half the amount of memory
4539 available)
4540 global
4541 {not in Vi}
4542 Maximum amount of memory (in Kbyte) to use for all buffers together.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004543 Maximum value 2000000. Use this to work without a limit. Also see
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004544 'maxmem'.
4545
4546 *'menuitems'* *'mis'*
4547'menuitems' 'mis' number (default 25)
4548 global
4549 {not in Vi}
4550 {not available when compiled without the |+menu|
4551 feature}
4552 Maximum number of items to use in a menu. Used for menus that are
4553 generated from a list of items, e.g., the Buffers menu. Changing this
4554 option has no direct effect, the menu must be refreshed first.
4555
Bram Moolenaar8aff23a2005-08-19 20:40:30 +00004556 *'mkspellmem'* *'msm'*
4557'mkspellmem' 'msm' string (default "460000,2000,500")
4558 global
4559 {not in Vi}
4560 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
4561 feature}
4562 Parameters for |:mkspell|. This tunes when to start compressing the
4563 word tree. Compression can be slow when there are many words, but
4564 it's needed to avoid running out of memory. The amount of memory used
4565 per word depends very much on how similar the words are, that's why
4566 this tuning is complicated.
4567
4568 There are three numbers, separated by commas:
4569 {start},{inc},{added}
4570
4571 For most languages the uncompressed word tree fits in memory. {start}
4572 gives the amount of memory in Kbyte that can be used before any
4573 compression is done. It should be a bit smaller than the amount of
4574 memory that is available to Vim.
4575
4576 When going over the {start} limit the {inc} number specifies the
4577 amount of memory in Kbyte that can be allocated before another
4578 compression is done. A low number means compression is done after
4579 less words are added, which is slow. A high number means more memory
4580 will be allocated.
4581
4582 After doing compression, {added} times 1024 words can be added before
4583 the {inc} limit is ignored and compression is done when any extra
4584 amount of memory is needed. A low number means there is a smaller
4585 chance of hitting the {inc} limit, less memory is used but it's
4586 slower.
4587
4588 The languages for which these numbers are important are Italian and
4589 Hungarian. The default works for when you have about 512 Mbyte. If
4590 you have 1 Gbyte you could use: >
4591 :set mkspellmem=900000,3000,800
4592< If you have less than 512 Mbyte |:mkspell| may fail for some
4593 languages, no matter what you set 'mkspellmem' to.
4594
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004595 *'modeline'* *'ml'* *'nomodeline'* *'noml'*
Bram Moolenaar8243a792007-05-01 17:05:03 +00004596'modeline' 'ml' boolean (Vim default: on (off for root),
4597 Vi default: off)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004598 local to buffer
4599 *'modelines'* *'mls'*
4600'modelines' 'mls' number (default 5)
4601 global
4602 {not in Vi}
4603 If 'modeline' is on 'modelines' gives the number of lines that is
4604 checked for set commands. If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is zero
4605 no lines are checked. See |modeline|.
4606 NOTE: 'modeline' is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
4607 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
4608
4609 *'modifiable'* *'ma'* *'nomodifiable'* *'noma'*
4610'modifiable' 'ma' boolean (default on)
4611 local to buffer
4612 {not in Vi} *E21*
4613 When off the buffer contents cannot be changed. The 'fileformat' and
4614 'fileencoding' options also can't be changed.
4615 Can be reset with the |-M| command line argument.
4616
4617 *'modified'* *'mod'* *'nomodified'* *'nomod'*
4618'modified' 'mod' boolean (default off)
4619 local to buffer
4620 {not in Vi}
4621 When on, the buffer is considered to be modified. This option is set
4622 when:
4623 1. A change was made to the text since it was last written. Using the
4624 |undo| command to go back to the original text will reset the
4625 option. But undoing changes that were made before writing the
4626 buffer will set the option again, since the text is different from
4627 when it was written.
4628 2. 'fileformat' or 'fileencoding' is different from its original
4629 value. The original value is set when the buffer is read or
4630 written. A ":set nomodified" command also resets the original
4631 values to the current values and the 'modified' option will be
4632 reset.
4633 When 'buftype' is "nowrite" or "nofile" this option may be set, but
4634 will be ignored.
4635
4636 *'more'* *'nomore'*
4637'more' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
4638 global
4639 {not in Vi}
4640 When on, listings pause when the whole screen is filled. You will get
4641 the |more-prompt|. When this option is off there are no pauses, the
4642 listing continues until finished.
4643 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
4644 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
4645
4646 *'mouse'* *E538*
4647'mouse' string (default "", "a" for GUI, MS-DOS and Win32)
4648 global
4649 {not in Vi}
4650 Enable the use of the mouse. Only works for certain terminals
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00004651 (xterm, MS-DOS, Win32 |win32-mouse|, QNX pterm, *BSD console with
4652 sysmouse and Linux console with gpm). For using the mouse in the
4653 GUI, see |gui-mouse|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004654 The mouse can be enabled for different modes:
4655 n Normal mode
4656 v Visual mode
4657 i Insert mode
4658 c Command-line mode
4659 h all previous modes when editing a help file
4660 a all previous modes
4661 r for |hit-enter| and |more-prompt| prompt
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004662 Normally you would enable the mouse in all four modes with: >
4663 :set mouse=a
4664< When the mouse is not enabled, the GUI will still use the mouse for
4665 modeless selection. This doesn't move the text cursor.
4666
4667 See |mouse-using|. Also see |'clipboard'|.
4668
4669 Note: When enabling the mouse in a terminal, copy/paste will use the
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004670 "* register if there is access to an X-server. The xterm handling of
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004671 the mouse buttons can still be used by keeping the shift key pressed.
4672 Also see the 'clipboard' option.
4673
4674 *'mousefocus'* *'mousef'* *'nomousefocus'* *'nomousef'*
4675'mousefocus' 'mousef' boolean (default off)
4676 global
4677 {not in Vi}
4678 {only works in the GUI}
4679 The window that the mouse pointer is on is automatically activated.
4680 When changing the window layout or window focus in another way, the
4681 mouse pointer is moved to the window with keyboard focus. Off is the
4682 default because it makes using the pull down menus a little goofy, as
4683 a pointer transit may activate a window unintentionally.
4684
4685 *'mousehide'* *'mh'* *'nomousehide'* *'nomh'*
4686'mousehide' 'mh' boolean (default on)
4687 global
4688 {not in Vi}
4689 {only works in the GUI}
4690 When on, the mouse pointer is hidden when characters are typed.
4691 The mouse pointer is restored when the mouse is moved.
4692
4693 *'mousemodel'* *'mousem'*
4694'mousemodel' 'mousem' string (default "extend", "popup" for MS-DOS and Win32)
4695 global
4696 {not in Vi}
4697 Sets the model to use for the mouse. The name mostly specifies what
4698 the right mouse button is used for:
4699 extend Right mouse button extends a selection. This works
4700 like in an xterm.
4701 popup Right mouse button pops up a menu. The shifted left
4702 mouse button extends a selection. This works like
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00004703 with Microsoft Windows.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004704 popup_setpos Like "popup", but the cursor will be moved to the
4705 position where the mouse was clicked, and thus the
4706 selected operation will act upon the clicked object.
4707 If clicking inside a selection, that selection will
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00004708 be acted upon, i.e. no cursor move. This implies of
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004709 course, that right clicking outside a selection will
4710 end Visual mode.
4711 Overview of what button does what for each model:
4712 mouse extend popup(_setpos) ~
4713 left click place cursor place cursor
4714 left drag start selection start selection
4715 shift-left search word extend selection
4716 right click extend selection popup menu (place cursor)
4717 right drag extend selection -
4718 middle click paste paste
4719
4720 In the "popup" model the right mouse button produces a pop-up menu.
4721 You need to define this first, see |popup-menu|.
4722
4723 Note that you can further refine the meaning of buttons with mappings.
4724 See |gui-mouse-mapping|. But mappings are NOT used for modeless
4725 selection (because that's handled in the GUI code directly).
4726
4727 The 'mousemodel' option is set by the |:behave| command.
4728
4729 *'mouseshape'* *'mouses'* *E547*
4730'mouseshape' 'mouses' string (default "i:beam,r:beam,s:updown,sd:cross,
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00004731 m:no,ml:up-arrow,v:rightup-arrow")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004732 global
4733 {not in Vi}
4734 {only available when compiled with the |+mouseshape|
4735 feature}
4736 This option tells Vim what the mouse pointer should look like in
4737 different modes. The option is a comma separated list of parts, much
4738 like used for 'guicursor'. Each part consist of a mode/location-list
4739 and an argument-list:
4740 mode-list:shape,mode-list:shape,..
4741 The mode-list is a dash separated list of these modes/locations:
4742 In a normal window: ~
4743 n Normal mode
4744 v Visual mode
4745 ve Visual mode with 'selection' "exclusive" (same as 'v',
4746 if not specified)
4747 o Operator-pending mode
4748 i Insert mode
4749 r Replace mode
4750
4751 Others: ~
4752 c appending to the command-line
4753 ci inserting in the command-line
4754 cr replacing in the command-line
4755 m at the 'Hit ENTER' or 'More' prompts
4756 ml idem, but cursor in the last line
4757 e any mode, pointer below last window
4758 s any mode, pointer on a status line
4759 sd any mode, while dragging a status line
4760 vs any mode, pointer on a vertical separator line
4761 vd any mode, while dragging a vertical separator line
4762 a everywhere
4763
4764 The shape is one of the following:
4765 avail name looks like ~
4766 w x arrow Normal mouse pointer
4767 w x blank no pointer at all (use with care!)
4768 w x beam I-beam
4769 w x updown up-down sizing arrows
4770 w x leftright left-right sizing arrows
4771 w x busy The system's usual busy pointer
4772 w x no The system's usual 'no input' pointer
4773 x udsizing indicates up-down resizing
4774 x lrsizing indicates left-right resizing
4775 x crosshair like a big thin +
4776 x hand1 black hand
4777 x hand2 white hand
4778 x pencil what you write with
4779 x question big ?
4780 x rightup-arrow arrow pointing right-up
4781 w x up-arrow arrow pointing up
4782 x <number> any X11 pointer number (see X11/cursorfont.h)
4783
4784 The "avail" column contains a 'w' if the shape is available for Win32,
4785 x for X11.
4786 Any modes not specified or shapes not available use the normal mouse
4787 pointer.
4788
4789 Example: >
4790 :set mouseshape=s:udsizing,m:no
4791< will make the mouse turn to a sizing arrow over the status lines and
4792 indicate no input when the hit-enter prompt is displayed (since
4793 clicking the mouse has no effect in this state.)
4794
4795 *'mousetime'* *'mouset'*
4796'mousetime' 'mouset' number (default 500)
4797 global
4798 {not in Vi}
4799 Only for GUI, MS-DOS, Win32 and Unix with xterm. Defines the maximum
4800 time in msec between two mouse clicks for the second click to be
4801 recognized as a multi click.
4802
Bram Moolenaar325b7a22004-07-05 15:58:32 +00004803 *'mzquantum'* *'mzq'*
4804'mzquantum' 'mzq' number (default 100)
4805 global
4806 {not in Vi}
4807 {not available when compiled without the |+mzscheme|
4808 feature}
4809 The number of milliseconds between polls for MzScheme threads.
4810 Negative or zero value means no thread scheduling.
4811
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004812 *'nrformats'* *'nf'*
4813'nrformats' 'nf' string (default "octal,hex")
4814 local to buffer
4815 {not in Vi}
4816 This defines what bases Vim will consider for numbers when using the
4817 CTRL-A and CTRL-X commands for adding to and subtracting from a number
4818 respectively; see |CTRL-A| for more info on these commands.
Bram Moolenaar4770d092006-01-12 23:22:24 +00004819 alpha If included, single alphabetical characters will be
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004820 incremented or decremented. This is useful for a list with a
4821 letter index a), b), etc.
Bram Moolenaar4770d092006-01-12 23:22:24 +00004822 octal If included, numbers that start with a zero will be considered
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004823 to be octal. Example: Using CTRL-A on "007" results in "010".
Bram Moolenaar4770d092006-01-12 23:22:24 +00004824 hex If included, numbers starting with "0x" or "0X" will be
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004825 considered to be hexadecimal. Example: Using CTRL-X on
4826 "0x100" results in "0x0ff".
4827 Numbers which simply begin with a digit in the range 1-9 are always
4828 considered decimal. This also happens for numbers that are not
4829 recognized as octal or hex.
4830
4831 *'number'* *'nu'* *'nonumber'* *'nonu'*
4832'number' 'nu' boolean (default off)
4833 local to window
4834 Print the line number in front of each line. When the 'n' option is
4835 excluded from 'cpoptions' a wrapped line will not use the column of
4836 line numbers (this is the default when 'compatible' isn't set).
Bram Moolenaar592e0a22004-07-03 16:05:59 +00004837 The 'numberwidth' option can be used to set the room used for the line
4838 number.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004839 When a long, wrapped line doesn't start with the first character, '-'
4840 characters are put before the number.
4841 See |hl-LineNr| for the highlighting used for the number.
4842
Bram Moolenaar592e0a22004-07-03 16:05:59 +00004843 *'numberwidth'* *'nuw'*
4844'numberwidth' 'nuw' number (Vim default: 4 Vi default: 8)
4845 local to window
Bram Moolenaar325b7a22004-07-05 15:58:32 +00004846 {not in Vi}
4847 {only available when compiled with the |+linebreak|
4848 feature}
Bram Moolenaar592e0a22004-07-03 16:05:59 +00004849 Minimal number of columns to use for the line number. Only relevant
Bram Moolenaar5e3cb7e2006-02-27 23:58:35 +00004850 when the 'number' option is set or printing lines with a line number.
Bram Moolenaar592e0a22004-07-03 16:05:59 +00004851 Since one space is always between the number and the text, there is
4852 one less character for the number itself.
4853 The value is the minimum width. A bigger width is used when needed to
4854 fit the highest line number in the buffer. Thus with the Vim default
4855 of 4 there is room for a line number up to 999. When the buffer has
4856 1000 lines five columns will be used.
4857 The minimum value is 1, the maximum value is 10.
4858 NOTE: 'numberwidth' is reset to 8 when 'compatible' is set.
4859
Bram Moolenaarf75a9632005-09-13 21:20:47 +00004860 *'omnifunc'* *'ofu'*
4861'omnifunc' 'ofu' string (default: empty)
Bram Moolenaare344bea2005-09-01 20:46:49 +00004862 local to buffer
4863 {not in Vi}
4864 {not available when compiled without the +eval
4865 or +insert_expand feature}
Bram Moolenaarc7486e02005-12-29 22:48:26 +00004866 This option specifies a function to be used for Insert mode omni
4867 completion with CTRL-X CTRL-O. |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-O|
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00004868 See |complete-functions| for an explanation of how the function is
4869 invoked and what it should return.
Bram Moolenaar043545e2006-10-10 16:44:07 +00004870 This option is usually set by a filetype plugin:
Bram Moolenaar9c102382006-05-03 21:26:49 +00004871 |:filetype-plugin-on|
Bram Moolenaare344bea2005-09-01 20:46:49 +00004872
4873
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00004874 *'opendevice'* *'odev'* *'noopendevice'* *'noodev'*
Bram Moolenaar043545e2006-10-10 16:44:07 +00004875'opendevice' 'odev' boolean (default off)
4876 global
4877 {not in Vi}
4878 {only for MS-DOS, MS-Windows and OS/2}
4879 Enable reading and writing from devices. This may get Vim stuck on a
4880 device that can be opened but doesn't actually do the I/O. Therefore
4881 it is off by default.
4882 Note that on MS-Windows editing "aux.h", "lpt1.txt" and the like also
4883 result in editing a device.
4884
4885
Bram Moolenaar2c7a29c2005-12-12 22:02:31 +00004886 *'operatorfunc'* *'opfunc'*
4887'operatorfunc' 'opfunc' string (default: empty)
4888 global
4889 {not in Vi}
4890 This option specifies a function to be called by the |g@| operator.
4891 See |:map-operator| for more info and an example.
4892
4893 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
4894 security reasons.
4895
4896
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004897 *'osfiletype'* *'oft'* *E366*
4898'osfiletype' 'oft' string (RISC-OS default: "Text",
4899 others default: "")
4900 local to buffer
4901 {not in Vi}
4902 {only available when compiled with the |+osfiletype|
4903 feature}
4904 Some operating systems store extra information about files besides
4905 name, datestamp and permissions. This option contains the extra
4906 information, the nature of which will vary between systems.
4907 The value of this option is usually set when the file is loaded, and
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00004908 is used to set the operating system file type when file is written.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004909 It can affect the pattern matching of the automatic commands.
4910 |autocmd-osfiletypes|
4911
4912 *'paragraphs'* *'para'*
Bram Moolenaar57e48462008-03-12 16:38:55 +00004913'paragraphs' 'para' string (default "IPLPPPQPP TPHPLIPpLpItpplpipbp")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004914 global
4915 Specifies the nroff macros that separate paragraphs. These are pairs
4916 of two letters (see |object-motions|).
4917
4918 *'paste'* *'nopaste'*
4919'paste' boolean (default off)
4920 global
4921 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004922 Put Vim in Paste mode. This is useful if you want to cut or copy
4923 some text from one window and paste it in Vim. This will avoid
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004924 unexpected effects.
4925 Setting this option is useful when using Vim in a terminal, where Vim
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004926 cannot distinguish between typed text and pasted text. In the GUI, Vim
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004927 knows about pasting and will mostly do the right thing without 'paste'
4928 being set. The same is true for a terminal where Vim handles the
4929 mouse clicks itself.
Bram Moolenaar2ce06f62005-01-31 19:19:04 +00004930 This option is reset when starting the GUI. Thus if you set it in
4931 your .vimrc it will work in a terminal, but not in the GUI. Setting
4932 'paste' in the GUI has side effects: e.g., the Paste toolbar button
4933 will no longer work in Insert mode, because it uses a mapping.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004934 When the 'paste' option is switched on (also when it was already on):
4935 - mapping in Insert mode and Command-line mode is disabled
4936 - abbreviations are disabled
4937 - 'textwidth' is set to 0
4938 - 'wrapmargin' is set to 0
4939 - 'autoindent' is reset
4940 - 'smartindent' is reset
4941 - 'softtabstop' is set to 0
4942 - 'revins' is reset
4943 - 'ruler' is reset
4944 - 'showmatch' is reset
4945 - 'formatoptions' is used like it is empty
4946 These options keep their value, but their effect is disabled:
4947 - 'lisp'
4948 - 'indentexpr'
4949 - 'cindent'
4950 NOTE: When you start editing another file while the 'paste' option is
4951 on, settings from the modelines or autocommands may change the
4952 settings again, causing trouble when pasting text. You might want to
4953 set the 'paste' option again.
4954 When the 'paste' option is reset the mentioned options are restored to
4955 the value before the moment 'paste' was switched from off to on.
4956 Resetting 'paste' before ever setting it does not have any effect.
4957 Since mapping doesn't work while 'paste' is active, you need to use
4958 the 'pastetoggle' option to toggle the 'paste' option with some key.
4959
4960 *'pastetoggle'* *'pt'*
4961'pastetoggle' 'pt' string (default "")
4962 global
4963 {not in Vi}
4964 When non-empty, specifies the key sequence that toggles the 'paste'
4965 option. This is like specifying a mapping: >
4966 :map {keys} :set invpaste<CR>
4967< Where {keys} is the value of 'pastetoggle'.
4968 The difference is that it will work even when 'paste' is set.
4969 'pastetoggle' works in Insert mode and Normal mode, but not in
4970 Command-line mode.
4971 Mappings are checked first, thus overrule 'pastetoggle'. However,
4972 when 'paste' is on mappings are ignored in Insert mode, thus you can do
4973 this: >
4974 :map <F10> :set paste<CR>
4975 :map <F11> :set nopaste<CR>
4976 :imap <F10> <C-O>:set paste<CR>
4977 :imap <F11> <nop>
4978 :set pastetoggle=<F11>
4979< This will make <F10> start paste mode and <F11> stop paste mode.
4980 Note that typing <F10> in paste mode inserts "<F10>", since in paste
4981 mode everything is inserted literally, except the 'pastetoggle' key
4982 sequence.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00004983 When the value has several bytes 'ttimeoutlen' applies.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004984
4985 *'pex'* *'patchexpr'*
4986'patchexpr' 'pex' string (default "")
4987 global
4988 {not in Vi}
4989 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
4990 feature}
4991 Expression which is evaluated to apply a patch to a file and generate
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004992 the resulting new version of the file. See |diff-patchexpr|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004993
4994 *'patchmode'* *'pm'* *E206*
4995'patchmode' 'pm' string (default "")
4996 global
4997 {not in Vi}
4998 When non-empty the oldest version of a file is kept. This can be used
4999 to keep the original version of a file if you are changing files in a
5000 source distribution. Only the first time that a file is written a
5001 copy of the original file will be kept. The name of the copy is the
5002 name of the original file with the string in the 'patchmode' option
5003 appended. This option should start with a dot. Use a string like
5004 ".org". 'backupdir' must not be empty for this to work (Detail: The
5005 backup file is renamed to the patchmode file after the new file has
5006 been successfully written, that's why it must be possible to write a
5007 backup file). If there was no file to be backed up, an empty file is
5008 created.
5009 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a patchmode file is not made.
5010 Using 'patchmode' for compressed files appends the extension at the
5011 end (e.g., "file.gz.orig"), thus the resulting name isn't always
5012 recognized as a compressed file.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00005013 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005014
5015 *'path'* *'pa'* *E343* *E345* *E347*
5016'path' 'pa' string (default on Unix: ".,/usr/include,,"
5017 on OS/2: ".,/emx/include,,"
5018 other systems: ".,,")
5019 global or local to buffer |global-local|
5020 {not in Vi}
5021 This is a list of directories which will be searched when using the
Bram Moolenaarc236c162008-07-13 17:41:49 +00005022 |gf|, [f, ]f, ^Wf, |:find|, |:sfind|, |:tabfind| and other commands,
5023 provided that the file being searched for has a relative path (not
5024 starting with "/", "./" or "../"). The directories in the 'path'
5025 option may be relative or absolute.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005026 - Use commas to separate directory names: >
5027 :set path=.,/usr/local/include,/usr/include
5028< - Spaces can also be used to separate directory names (for backwards
5029 compatibility with version 3.0). To have a space in a directory
5030 name, precede it with an extra backslash, and escape the space: >
5031 :set path=.,/dir/with\\\ space
5032< - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with an extra
5033 backslash: >
5034 :set path=.,/dir/with\\,comma
5035< - To search relative to the directory of the current file, use: >
5036 :set path=.
5037< - To search in the current directory use an empty string between two
5038 commas: >
5039 :set path=,,
5040< - A directory name may end in a ':' or '/'.
5041 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
5042 - When using |netrw.vim| URLs can be used. For example, adding
5043 "http://www.vim.org" will make ":find index.html" work.
Bram Moolenaarc236c162008-07-13 17:41:49 +00005044 - Search upwards and downwards in a directory tree using "*", "**" and
5045 ";". See |file-searching| for info and syntax.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005046 {not available when compiled without the |+path_extra| feature}
5047 - Careful with '\' characters, type two to get one in the option: >
5048 :set path=.,c:\\include
5049< Or just use '/' instead: >
5050 :set path=.,c:/include
5051< Don't forget "." or files won't even be found in the same directory as
5052 the file!
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005053 The maximum length is limited. How much depends on the system, mostly
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005054 it is something like 256 or 1024 characters.
5055 You can check if all the include files are found, using the value of
5056 'path', see |:checkpath|.
5057 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
5058 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
5059 uses another default. To remove the current directory use: >
5060 :set path-=
5061< To add the current directory use: >
5062 :set path+=
5063< To use an environment variable, you probably need to replace the
5064 separator. Here is an example to append $INCL, in which directory
5065 names are separated with a semi-colon: >
5066 :let &path = &path . "," . substitute($INCL, ';', ',', 'g')
5067< Replace the ';' with a ':' or whatever separator is used. Note that
5068 this doesn't work when $INCL contains a comma or white space.
5069
5070 *'preserveindent'* *'pi'* *'nopreserveindent'* *'nopi'*
5071'preserveindent' 'pi' boolean (default off)
5072 local to buffer
5073 {not in Vi}
5074 When changing the indent of the current line, preserve as much of the
5075 indent structure as possible. Normally the indent is replaced by a
5076 series of tabs followed by spaces as required (unless |'expandtab'| is
5077 enabled, in which case only spaces are used). Enabling this option
5078 means the indent will preserve as many existing characters as possible
5079 for indenting, and only add additional tabs or spaces as required.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00005080 'expandtab' does not apply to the preserved white space, a Tab remains
5081 a Tab.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005082 NOTE: When using ">>" multiple times the resulting indent is a mix of
5083 tabs and spaces. You might not like this.
5084 NOTE: 'preserveindent' is reset when 'compatible' is set.
5085 Also see 'copyindent'.
5086 Use |:retab| to clean up white space.
5087
5088 *'previewheight'* *'pvh'*
5089'previewheight' 'pvh' number (default 12)
5090 global
5091 {not in Vi}
5092 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| or
5093 |+quickfix| feature}
5094 Default height for a preview window. Used for |:ptag| and associated
5095 commands. Used for |CTRL-W_}| when no count is given.
5096
5097 *'previewwindow'* *'nopreviewwindow'*
5098 *'pvw'* *'nopvw'* *E590*
5099'previewwindow' 'pvw' boolean (default off)
5100 local to window
5101 {not in Vi}
5102 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| or
5103 |+quickfix| feature}
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005104 Identifies the preview window. Only one window can have this option
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005105 set. It's normally not set directly, but by using one of the commands
5106 |:ptag|, |:pedit|, etc.
5107
5108 *'printdevice'* *'pdev'*
5109'printdevice' 'pdev' string (default empty)
5110 global
5111 {not in Vi}
5112 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
5113 feature}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005114 The name of the printer to be used for |:hardcopy|.
5115 See |pdev-option|.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00005116 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5117 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005118
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005119 *'printencoding'* *'penc'*
5120'printencoding' 'penc' String (default empty, except for some systems)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005121 global
5122 {not in Vi}
5123 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
5124 and |+postscript| features}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005125 Sets the character encoding used when printing.
5126 See |penc-option|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005127
5128 *'printexpr'* *'pexpr'*
5129'printexpr' 'pexpr' String (default: see below)
5130 global
5131 {not in Vi}
5132 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
5133 and |+postscript| features}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005134 Expression used to print the PostScript produced with |:hardcopy|.
5135 See |pexpr-option|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005136
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005137 *'printfont'* *'pfn'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005138'printfont' 'pfn' string (default "courier")
5139 global
5140 {not in Vi}
5141 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
5142 feature}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005143 The name of the font that will be used for |:hardcopy|.
5144 See |pfn-option|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005145
5146 *'printheader'* *'pheader'*
5147'printheader' 'pheader' string (default "%<%f%h%m%=Page %N")
5148 global
5149 {not in Vi}
5150 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
5151 feature}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005152 The format of the header produced in |:hardcopy| output.
5153 See |pheader-option|.
5154
5155 *'printmbcharset'* *'pmbcs'*
5156'printmbcharset' 'pmbcs' string (default "")
5157 global
5158 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaarbc7aa852005-03-06 23:38:09 +00005159 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|,
5160 |+postscript| and |+multi_byte| features}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005161 The CJK character set to be used for CJK output from |:hardcopy|.
5162 See |pmbcs-option|.
5163
5164 *'printmbfont'* *'pmbfn'*
5165'printmbfont' 'pmbfn' string (default "")
5166 global
5167 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaarbc7aa852005-03-06 23:38:09 +00005168 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|,
5169 |+postscript| and |+multi_byte| features}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005170 List of font names to be used for CJK output from |:hardcopy|.
5171 See |pmbfn-option|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005172
5173 *'printoptions'* *'popt'*
5174'printoptions' 'popt' string (default "")
5175 global
5176 {not in Vi}
5177 {only available when compiled with |+printer| feature}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005178 List of items that control the format of the output of |:hardcopy|.
5179 See |popt-option|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005180
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00005181 *'prompt'* *'noprompt'*
5182'prompt' boolean (default on)
5183 global
5184 When on a ":" prompt is used in Ex mode.
5185
Bram Moolenaar7d47b6e2006-03-15 22:59:18 +00005186 *'pumheight'* *'ph'*
5187'pumheight' 'ph' number (default 0)
5188 global
5189 {not available when compiled without the
5190 |+insert_expand| feature}
5191 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar06a89a52006-04-29 22:01:03 +00005192 Determines the maximum number of items to show in the popup menu for
5193 Insert mode completion. When zero as much space as available is used.
Bram Moolenaar7d47b6e2006-03-15 22:59:18 +00005194 |ins-completion-menu|.
5195
5196
Bram Moolenaar677ee682005-01-27 14:41:15 +00005197 *'quoteescape'* *'qe'*
Bram Moolenaarcfbc5ee2004-07-02 15:38:35 +00005198'quoteescape' 'qe' string (default "\")
5199 local to buffer
5200 {not in Vi}
5201 The characters that are used to escape quotes in a string. Used for
5202 objects like a', a" and a` |a'|.
5203 When one of the characters in this option is found inside a string,
5204 the following character will be skipped. The default value makes the
5205 text "foo\"bar\\" considered to be one string.
5206
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005207 *'readonly'* *'ro'* *'noreadonly'* *'noro'*
5208'readonly' 'ro' boolean (default off)
5209 local to buffer
5210 If on, writes fail unless you use a '!'. Protects you from
5211 accidentally overwriting a file. Default on when Vim is started
5212 in read-only mode ("vim -R") or when the executable is called "view".
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00005213 When using ":w!" the 'readonly' option is reset for the current
5214 buffer, unless the 'Z' flag is in 'cpoptions'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005215 {not in Vi:} When using the ":view" command the 'readonly' option is
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00005216 set for the newly edited buffer.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005217
Bram Moolenaar91a4e822008-01-19 14:59:58 +00005218 *'redrawtime'* *'rdt'*
5219'redrawtime' 'rdt' number (default 2000)
5220 global
5221 {not in Vi}
5222 {only available when compiled with the |+reltime|
5223 feature}
5224 The time in milliseconds for redrawing the display. This applies to
5225 searching for patterns for 'hlsearch' and |:match| highlighting.
5226 When redrawing takes more than this many milliseconds no further
5227 matches will be highlighted. This is used to avoid that Vim hangs
5228 when using a very complicated pattern.
5229
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005230 *'remap'* *'noremap'*
5231'remap' boolean (default on)
5232 global
5233 Allows for mappings to work recursively. If you do not want this for
5234 a single entry, use the :noremap[!] command.
Bram Moolenaara3227e22006-03-08 21:32:40 +00005235 NOTE: To avoid portability problems with Vim scripts, always keep
5236 this option at the default "on". Only switch it off when working with
5237 old Vi scripts.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005238
5239 *'report'*
5240'report' number (default 2)
5241 global
5242 Threshold for reporting number of lines changed. When the number of
5243 changed lines is more than 'report' a message will be given for most
5244 ":" commands. If you want it always, set 'report' to 0.
5245 For the ":substitute" command the number of substitutions is used
5246 instead of the number of lines.
5247
5248 *'restorescreen'* *'rs'* *'norestorescreen'* *'nors'*
5249'restorescreen' 'rs' boolean (default on)
5250 global
5251 {not in Vi} {only in Windows 95/NT console version}
5252 When set, the screen contents is restored when exiting Vim. This also
5253 happens when executing external commands.
5254
5255 For non-Windows Vim: You can set or reset the 't_ti' and 't_te'
5256 options in your .vimrc. To disable restoring:
5257 set t_ti= t_te=
5258 To enable restoring (for an xterm):
5259 set t_ti=^[7^[[r^[[?47h t_te=^[[?47l^[8
5260 (Where ^[ is an <Esc>, type CTRL-V <Esc> to insert it)
5261
5262 *'revins'* *'ri'* *'norevins'* *'nori'*
5263'revins' 'ri' boolean (default off)
5264 global
5265 {not in Vi}
5266 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
5267 feature}
5268 Inserting characters in Insert mode will work backwards. See "typing
5269 backwards" |ins-reverse|. This option can be toggled with the CTRL-_
5270 command in Insert mode, when 'allowrevins' is set.
5271 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' or 'paste' is set.
5272
5273 *'rightleft'* *'rl'* *'norightleft'* *'norl'*
5274'rightleft' 'rl' boolean (default off)
5275 local to window
5276 {not in Vi}
5277 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
5278 feature}
5279 When on, display orientation becomes right-to-left, i.e., characters
5280 that are stored in the file appear from the right to the left.
5281 Using this option, it is possible to edit files for languages that
5282 are written from the right to the left such as Hebrew and Arabic.
5283 This option is per window, so it is possible to edit mixed files
5284 simultaneously, or to view the same file in both ways (this is
5285 useful whenever you have a mixed text file with both right-to-left
5286 and left-to-right strings so that both sets are displayed properly
5287 in different windows). Also see |rileft.txt|.
5288
5289 *'rightleftcmd'* *'rlc'* *'norightleftcmd'* *'norlc'*
5290'rightleftcmd' 'rlc' string (default "search")
5291 local to window
5292 {not in Vi}
5293 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
5294 feature}
5295 Each word in this option enables the command line editing to work in
5296 right-to-left mode for a group of commands:
5297
5298 search "/" and "?" commands
5299
5300 This is useful for languages such as Hebrew, Arabic and Farsi.
5301 The 'rightleft' option must be set for 'rightleftcmd' to take effect.
5302
5303 *'ruler'* *'ru'* *'noruler'* *'noru'*
5304'ruler' 'ru' boolean (default off)
5305 global
5306 {not in Vi}
5307 {not available when compiled without the
5308 |+cmdline_info| feature}
5309 Show the line and column number of the cursor position, separated by a
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005310 comma. When there is room, the relative position of the displayed
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005311 text in the file is shown on the far right:
5312 Top first line is visible
5313 Bot last line is visible
5314 All first and last line are visible
5315 45% relative position in the file
5316 If 'rulerformat' is set, it will determine the contents of the ruler.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005317 Each window has its own ruler. If a window has a status line, the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005318 ruler is shown there. Otherwise it is shown in the last line of the
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00005319 screen. If the statusline is given by 'statusline' (i.e. not empty),
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005320 this option takes precedence over 'ruler' and 'rulerformat'
5321 If the number of characters displayed is different from the number of
5322 bytes in the text (e.g., for a TAB or a multi-byte character), both
5323 the text column (byte number) and the screen column are shown,
5324 separated with a dash.
5325 For an empty line "0-1" is shown.
5326 For an empty buffer the line number will also be zero: "0,0-1".
5327 This option is reset when the 'paste' option is set.
5328 If you don't want to see the ruler all the time but want to know where
5329 you are, use "g CTRL-G" |g_CTRL-G|.
5330 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
5331
5332 *'rulerformat'* *'ruf'*
5333'rulerformat' 'ruf' string (default empty)
5334 global
5335 {not in Vi}
5336 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline|
5337 feature}
5338 When this option is not empty, it determines the content of the ruler
5339 string, as displayed for the 'ruler' option.
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00005340 The format of this option is like that of 'statusline'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005341 The default ruler width is 17 characters. To make the ruler 15
5342 characters wide, put "%15(" at the start and "%)" at the end.
5343 Example: >
5344 :set rulerformat=%15(%c%V\ %p%%%)
5345<
5346 *'runtimepath'* *'rtp'* *vimfiles*
5347'runtimepath' 'rtp' string (default:
5348 Unix: "$HOME/.vim,
5349 $VIM/vimfiles,
5350 $VIMRUNTIME,
5351 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
5352 $HOME/.vim/after"
5353 Amiga: "home:vimfiles,
5354 $VIM/vimfiles,
5355 $VIMRUNTIME,
5356 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
5357 home:vimfiles/after"
5358 PC, OS/2: "$HOME/vimfiles,
5359 $VIM/vimfiles,
5360 $VIMRUNTIME,
5361 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
5362 $HOME/vimfiles/after"
5363 Macintosh: "$VIM:vimfiles,
5364 $VIMRUNTIME,
5365 $VIM:vimfiles:after"
5366 RISC-OS: "Choices:vimfiles,
5367 $VIMRUNTIME,
5368 Choices:vimfiles/after"
5369 VMS: "sys$login:vimfiles,
5370 $VIM/vimfiles,
5371 $VIMRUNTIME,
5372 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00005373 sys$login:vimfiles/after")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005374 global
5375 {not in Vi}
5376 This is a list of directories which will be searched for runtime
5377 files:
5378 filetype.vim filetypes by file name |new-filetype|
5379 scripts.vim filetypes by file contents |new-filetype-scripts|
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00005380 autoload/ automatically loaded scripts |autoload-functions|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005381 colors/ color scheme files |:colorscheme|
5382 compiler/ compiler files |:compiler|
5383 doc/ documentation |write-local-help|
5384 ftplugin/ filetype plugins |write-filetype-plugin|
5385 indent/ indent scripts |indent-expression|
5386 keymap/ key mapping files |mbyte-keymap|
5387 lang/ menu translations |:menutrans|
5388 menu.vim GUI menus |menu.vim|
5389 plugin/ plugin scripts |write-plugin|
5390 print/ files for printing |postscript-print-encoding|
Bram Moolenaarafeb4fa2006-02-01 21:51:12 +00005391 spell/ spell checking files |spell|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005392 syntax/ syntax files |mysyntaxfile|
5393 tutor/ files for vimtutor |tutor|
5394
5395 And any other file searched for with the |:runtime| command.
5396
5397 The defaults for most systems are setup to search five locations:
5398 1. In your home directory, for your personal preferences.
5399 2. In a system-wide Vim directory, for preferences from the system
5400 administrator.
5401 3. In $VIMRUNTIME, for files distributed with Vim.
5402 *after-directory*
5403 4. In the "after" directory in the system-wide Vim directory. This is
5404 for the system administrator to overrule or add to the distributed
5405 defaults (rarely needed)
5406 5. In the "after" directory in your home directory. This is for
5407 personal preferences to overrule or add to the distributed defaults
5408 or system-wide settings (rarely needed).
5409
5410 Note that, unlike 'path', no wildcards like "**" are allowed. Normal
5411 wildcards are allowed, but can significantly slow down searching for
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005412 runtime files. For speed, use as few items as possible and avoid
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005413 wildcards.
5414 See |:runtime|.
5415 Example: >
5416 :set runtimepath=~/vimruntime,/mygroup/vim,$VIMRUNTIME
5417< This will use the directory "~/vimruntime" first (containing your
5418 personal Vim runtime files), then "/mygroup/vim" (shared between a
5419 group of people) and finally "$VIMRUNTIME" (the distributed runtime
5420 files).
5421 You probably should always include $VIMRUNTIME somewhere, to use the
5422 distributed runtime files. You can put a directory before $VIMRUNTIME
5423 to find files which replace a distributed runtime files. You can put
5424 a directory after $VIMRUNTIME to find files which add to distributed
5425 runtime files.
5426 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5427 security reasons.
5428
5429 *'scroll'* *'scr'*
5430'scroll' 'scr' number (default: half the window height)
5431 local to window
5432 Number of lines to scroll with CTRL-U and CTRL-D commands. Will be
5433 set to half the number of lines in the window when the window size
5434 changes. If you give a count to the CTRL-U or CTRL-D command it will
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005435 be used as the new value for 'scroll'. Reset to half the window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005436 height with ":set scroll=0". {Vi is a bit different: 'scroll' gives
5437 the number of screen lines instead of file lines, makes a difference
5438 when lines wrap}
5439
5440 *'scrollbind'* *'scb'* *'noscrollbind'* *'noscb'*
5441'scrollbind' 'scb' boolean (default off)
5442 local to window
5443 {not in Vi}
5444 {not available when compiled without the |+scrollbind|
5445 feature}
5446 See also |scroll-binding|. When this option is set, the current
5447 window scrolls as other scrollbind windows (windows that also have
5448 this option set) scroll. This option is useful for viewing the
5449 differences between two versions of a file, see 'diff'.
5450 See |'scrollopt'| for options that determine how this option should be
5451 interpreted.
5452 This option is mostly reset when splitting a window to edit another
5453 file. This means that ":split | edit file" results in two windows
5454 with scroll-binding, but ":split file" does not.
5455
5456 *'scrolljump'* *'sj'*
5457'scrolljump' 'sj' number (default 1)
5458 global
5459 {not in Vi}
5460 Minimal number of lines to scroll when the cursor gets off the
5461 screen (e.g., with "j"). Not used for scroll commands (e.g., CTRL-E,
5462 CTRL-D). Useful if your terminal scrolls very slowly.
Bram Moolenaar1e015462005-09-25 22:16:38 +00005463 When set to a negative number from -1 to -100 this is used as the
5464 percentage of the window height. Thus -50 scrolls half the window
5465 height.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005466 NOTE: This option is set to 1 when 'compatible' is set.
5467
5468 *'scrolloff'* *'so'*
5469'scrolloff' 'so' number (default 0)
5470 global
5471 {not in Vi}
5472 Minimal number of screen lines to keep above and below the cursor.
5473 This will make some context visible around where you are working. If
5474 you set it to a very large value (999) the cursor line will always be
5475 in the middle of the window (except at the start or end of the file or
5476 when long lines wrap).
5477 For scrolling horizontally see 'sidescrolloff'.
5478 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
5479
5480 *'scrollopt'* *'sbo'*
5481'scrollopt' 'sbo' string (default "ver,jump")
5482 global
5483 {not available when compiled without the |+scrollbind|
5484 feature}
5485 {not in Vi}
5486 This is a comma-separated list of words that specifies how
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00005487 'scrollbind' windows should behave. 'sbo' stands for ScrollBind
5488 Options.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005489 The following words are available:
5490 ver Bind vertical scrolling for 'scrollbind' windows
5491 hor Bind horizontal scrolling for 'scrollbind' windows
5492 jump Applies to the offset between two windows for vertical
5493 scrolling. This offset is the difference in the first
5494 displayed line of the bound windows. When moving
5495 around in a window, another 'scrollbind' window may
5496 reach a position before the start or after the end of
5497 the buffer. The offset is not changed though, when
5498 moving back the 'scrollbind' window will try to scroll
5499 to the desired position when possible.
5500 When now making that window the current one, two
5501 things can be done with the relative offset:
5502 1. When "jump" is not included, the relative offset is
5503 adjusted for the scroll position in the new current
5504 window. When going back to the other window, the
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005505 new relative offset will be used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005506 2. When "jump" is included, the other windows are
5507 scrolled to keep the same relative offset. When
5508 going back to the other window, it still uses the
5509 same relative offset.
5510 Also see |scroll-binding|.
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00005511 When 'diff' mode is active there always is vertical scroll binding,
5512 even when "ver" isn't there.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005513
5514 *'sections'* *'sect'*
5515'sections' 'sect' string (default "SHNHH HUnhsh")
5516 global
5517 Specifies the nroff macros that separate sections. These are pairs of
5518 two letters (See |object-motions|). The default makes a section start
5519 at the nroff macros ".SH", ".NH", ".H", ".HU", ".nh" and ".sh".
5520
5521 *'secure'* *'nosecure'* *E523*
5522'secure' boolean (default off)
5523 global
5524 {not in Vi}
5525 When on, ":autocmd", shell and write commands are not allowed in
5526 ".vimrc" and ".exrc" in the current directory and map commands are
5527 displayed. Switch it off only if you know that you will not run into
5528 problems, or when the 'exrc' option is off. On Unix this option is
5529 only used if the ".vimrc" or ".exrc" is not owned by you. This can be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005530 dangerous if the systems allows users to do a "chown". You better set
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005531 'secure' at the end of your ~/.vimrc then.
5532 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5533 security reasons.
5534
5535 *'selection'* *'sel'*
5536'selection' 'sel' string (default "inclusive")
5537 global
5538 {not in Vi}
5539 This option defines the behavior of the selection. It is only used
5540 in Visual and Select mode.
5541 Possible values:
5542 value past line inclusive ~
5543 old no yes
5544 inclusive yes yes
5545 exclusive yes no
5546 "past line" means that the cursor is allowed to be positioned one
5547 character past the line.
5548 "inclusive" means that the last character of the selection is included
5549 in an operation. For example, when "x" is used to delete the
5550 selection.
5551 Note that when "exclusive" is used and selecting from the end
5552 backwards, you cannot include the last character of a line, when
5553 starting in Normal mode and 'virtualedit' empty.
5554
5555 The 'selection' option is set by the |:behave| command.
5556
5557 *'selectmode'* *'slm'*
5558'selectmode' 'slm' string (default "")
5559 global
5560 {not in Vi}
5561 This is a comma separated list of words, which specifies when to start
5562 Select mode instead of Visual mode, when a selection is started.
5563 Possible values:
5564 mouse when using the mouse
5565 key when using shifted special keys
5566 cmd when using "v", "V" or CTRL-V
5567 See |Select-mode|.
5568 The 'selectmode' option is set by the |:behave| command.
5569
5570 *'sessionoptions'* *'ssop'*
5571'sessionoptions' 'ssop' string (default: "blank,buffers,curdir,folds,
Bram Moolenaar18144c82006-04-12 21:52:12 +00005572 help,options,tabpages,winsize")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005573 global
5574 {not in Vi}
5575 {not available when compiled without the +mksession
5576 feature}
5577 Changes the effect of the |:mksession| command. It is a comma
5578 separated list of words. Each word enables saving and restoring
5579 something:
5580 word save and restore ~
5581 blank empty windows
5582 buffers hidden and unloaded buffers, not just those in windows
5583 curdir the current directory
5584 folds manually created folds, opened/closed folds and local
5585 fold options
5586 globals global variables that start with an uppercase letter
Bram Moolenaar12805862005-01-05 22:16:17 +00005587 and contain at least one lowercase letter. Only
5588 String and Number types are stored.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005589 help the help window
5590 localoptions options and mappings local to a window or buffer (not
5591 global values for local options)
5592 options all options and mappings (also global values for local
5593 options)
5594 resize size of the Vim window: 'lines' and 'columns'
5595 sesdir the directory in which the session file is located
5596 will become the current directory (useful with
5597 projects accessed over a network from different
5598 systems)
5599 slash backslashes in file names replaced with forward
5600 slashes
Bram Moolenaar18144c82006-04-12 21:52:12 +00005601 tabpages all tab pages; without this only the current tab page
5602 is restored, so that you can make a session for each
5603 tab page separately
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005604 unix with Unix end-of-line format (single <NL>), even when
5605 on Windows or DOS
5606 winpos position of the whole Vim window
5607 winsize window sizes
5608
5609 Don't include both "curdir" and "sesdir".
5610 When "curdir" nor "sesdir" is included, file names are stored with
5611 absolute paths.
5612 "slash" and "unix" are useful on Windows when sharing session files
5613 with Unix. The Unix version of Vim cannot source dos format scripts,
5614 but the Windows version of Vim can source unix format scripts.
5615
5616 *'shell'* *'sh'* *E91*
5617'shell' 'sh' string (default $SHELL or "sh",
5618 MS-DOS and Win32: "command.com" or
5619 "cmd.exe", OS/2: "cmd")
5620 global
5621 Name of the shell to use for ! and :! commands. When changing the
5622 value also check these options: 'shelltype', 'shellpipe', 'shellslash'
5623 'shellredir', 'shellquote', 'shellxquote' and 'shellcmdflag'.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005624 It is allowed to give an argument to the command, e.g. "csh -f".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005625 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
5626 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
5627 If the name of the shell contains a space, you might need to enclose
5628 it in quotes. Example: >
5629 :set shell=\"c:\program\ files\unix\sh.exe\"\ -f
5630< Note the backslash before each quote (to avoid starting a comment) and
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005631 each space (to avoid ending the option value). Also note that the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005632 "-f" is not inside the quotes, because it is not part of the command
5633 name. And Vim automagically recognizes the backslashes that are path
5634 separators.
5635 For Dos 32 bits (DJGPP), you can set the $DJSYSFLAGS environment
5636 variable to change the way external commands are executed. See the
5637 libc.inf file of DJGPP.
5638 Under MS-Windows, when the executable ends in ".com" it must be
5639 included. Thus setting the shell to "command.com" or "4dos.com"
5640 works, but "command" and "4dos" do not work for all commands (e.g.,
5641 filtering).
5642 For unknown reasons, when using "4dos.com" the current directory is
5643 changed to "C:\". To avoid this set 'shell' like this: >
5644 :set shell=command.com\ /c\ 4dos
5645< This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5646 security reasons.
5647
5648 *'shellcmdflag'* *'shcf'*
5649'shellcmdflag' 'shcf' string (default: "-c", MS-DOS and Win32, when 'shell'
5650 does not contain "sh" somewhere: "/c")
5651 global
5652 {not in Vi}
5653 Flag passed to the shell to execute "!" and ":!" commands; e.g.,
5654 "bash.exe -c ls" or "command.com /c dir". For the MS-DOS-like
5655 systems, the default is set according to the value of 'shell', to
5656 reduce the need to set this option by the user. It's not used for
5657 OS/2 (EMX figures this out itself). See |option-backslash| about
5658 including spaces and backslashes. See |dos-shell|.
5659 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5660 security reasons.
5661
5662 *'shellpipe'* *'sp'*
5663'shellpipe' 'sp' string (default ">", "| tee", "|& tee" or "2>&1| tee")
5664 global
5665 {not in Vi}
5666 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
5667 feature}
5668 String to be used to put the output of the ":make" command in the
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005669 error file. See also |:make_makeprg|. See |option-backslash| about
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005670 including spaces and backslashes.
5671 The name of the temporary file can be represented by "%s" if necessary
5672 (the file name is appended automatically if no %s appears in the value
5673 of this option).
5674 For the Amiga and MS-DOS the default is ">". The output is directly
5675 saved in a file and not echoed to the screen.
5676 For Unix the default it "| tee". The stdout of the compiler is saved
5677 in a file and echoed to the screen. If the 'shell' option is "csh" or
5678 "tcsh" after initializations, the default becomes "|& tee". If the
5679 'shell' option is "sh", "ksh", "zsh" or "bash" the default becomes
5680 "2>&1| tee". This means that stderr is also included.
5681 The initialization of this option is done after reading the ".vimrc"
5682 and the other initializations, so that when the 'shell' option is set
5683 there, the 'shellpipe' option changes automatically, unless it was
5684 explicitly set before.
5685 When 'shellpipe' is set to an empty string, no redirection of the
5686 ":make" output will be done. This is useful if you use a 'makeprg'
5687 that writes to 'makeef' by itself. If you want no piping, but do
5688 want to include the 'makeef', set 'shellpipe' to a single space.
5689 Don't forget to precede the space with a backslash: ":set sp=\ ".
5690 In the future pipes may be used for filtering and this option will
5691 become obsolete (at least for Unix).
5692 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5693 security reasons.
5694
5695 *'shellquote'* *'shq'*
5696'shellquote' 'shq' string (default: ""; MS-DOS and Win32, when 'shell'
5697 contains "sh" somewhere: "\"")
5698 global
5699 {not in Vi}
5700 Quoting character(s), put around the command passed to the shell, for
5701 the "!" and ":!" commands. The redirection is kept outside of the
5702 quoting. See 'shellxquote' to include the redirection. It's
5703 probably not useful to set both options.
5704 This is an empty string by default. Only known to be useful for
5705 third-party shells on MS-DOS-like systems, such as the MKS Korn Shell
5706 or bash, where it should be "\"". The default is adjusted according
5707 the value of 'shell', to reduce the need to set this option by the
5708 user. See |dos-shell|.
5709 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5710 security reasons.
5711
5712 *'shellredir'* *'srr'*
5713'shellredir' 'srr' string (default ">", ">&" or ">%s 2>&1")
5714 global
5715 {not in Vi}
5716 String to be used to put the output of a filter command in a temporary
5717 file. See also |:!|. See |option-backslash| about including spaces
5718 and backslashes.
5719 The name of the temporary file can be represented by "%s" if necessary
5720 (the file name is appended automatically if no %s appears in the value
5721 of this option).
5722 The default is ">". For Unix, if the 'shell' option is "csh", "tcsh"
5723 or "zsh" during initializations, the default becomes ">&". If the
5724 'shell' option is "sh", "ksh" or "bash" the default becomes
5725 ">%s 2>&1". This means that stderr is also included.
5726 For Win32, the Unix checks are done and additionally "cmd" is checked
5727 for, which makes the default ">%s 2>&1". Also, the same names with
5728 ".exe" appended are checked for.
5729 The initialization of this option is done after reading the ".vimrc"
5730 and the other initializations, so that when the 'shell' option is set
5731 there, the 'shellredir' option changes automatically unless it was
5732 explicitly set before.
5733 In the future pipes may be used for filtering and this option will
5734 become obsolete (at least for Unix).
5735 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5736 security reasons.
5737
5738 *'shellslash'* *'ssl'* *'noshellslash'* *'nossl'*
5739'shellslash' 'ssl' boolean (default off)
5740 global
5741 {not in Vi} {only for MSDOS, MS-Windows and OS/2}
5742 When set, a forward slash is used when expanding file names. This is
5743 useful when a Unix-like shell is used instead of command.com or
5744 cmd.exe. Backward slashes can still be typed, but they are changed to
5745 forward slashes by Vim.
5746 Note that setting or resetting this option has no effect for some
5747 existing file names, thus this option needs to be set before opening
5748 any file for best results. This might change in the future.
5749 'shellslash' only works when a backslash can be used as a path
5750 separator. To test if this is so use: >
5751 if exists('+shellslash')
5752<
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00005753 *'shelltemp'* *'stmp'* *'noshelltemp'* *'nostmp'*
5754'shelltemp' 'stmp' boolean (Vi default off, Vim default on)
5755 global
5756 {not in Vi}
5757 When on, use temp files for shell commands. When off use a pipe.
5758 When using a pipe is not possible temp files are used anyway.
5759 Currently a pipe is only supported on Unix. You can check it with: >
5760 :if has("filterpipe")
5761< The advantage of using a pipe is that nobody can read the temp file
5762 and the 'shell' command does not need to support redirection.
5763 The advantage of using a temp file is that the file type and encoding
5764 can be detected.
5765 The |FilterReadPre|, |FilterReadPost| and |FilterWritePre|,
5766 |FilterWritePost| autocommands event are not triggered when
5767 'shelltemp' is off.
5768
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005769 *'shelltype'* *'st'*
5770'shelltype' 'st' number (default 0)
5771 global
5772 {not in Vi} {only for the Amiga}
5773 On the Amiga this option influences the way how the commands work
5774 which use a shell.
5775 0 and 1: always use the shell
5776 2 and 3: use the shell only to filter lines
5777 4 and 5: use shell only for ':sh' command
5778 When not using the shell, the command is executed directly.
5779
5780 0 and 2: use "shell 'shellcmdflag' cmd" to start external commands
5781 1 and 3: use "shell cmd" to start external commands
5782
5783 *'shellxquote'* *'sxq'*
5784'shellxquote' 'sxq' string (default: "";
5785 for Win32, when 'shell' contains "sh"
5786 somewhere: "\""
5787 for Unix, when using system(): "\"")
5788 global
5789 {not in Vi}
5790 Quoting character(s), put around the command passed to the shell, for
5791 the "!" and ":!" commands. Includes the redirection. See
5792 'shellquote' to exclude the redirection. It's probably not useful
5793 to set both options.
5794 This is an empty string by default. Known to be useful for
5795 third-party shells when using the Win32 version, such as the MKS Korn
5796 Shell or bash, where it should be "\"". The default is adjusted
5797 according the value of 'shell', to reduce the need to set this option
5798 by the user. See |dos-shell|.
5799 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5800 security reasons.
5801
5802 *'shiftround'* *'sr'* *'noshiftround'* *'nosr'*
5803'shiftround' 'sr' boolean (default off)
5804 global
5805 {not in Vi}
5806 Round indent to multiple of 'shiftwidth'. Applies to > and <
5807 commands. CTRL-T and CTRL-D in Insert mode always round the indent to
5808 a multiple of 'shiftwidth' (this is Vi compatible).
5809 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
5810
5811 *'shiftwidth'* *'sw'*
5812'shiftwidth' 'sw' number (default 8)
5813 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005814 Number of spaces to use for each step of (auto)indent. Used for
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005815 |'cindent'|, |>>|, |<<|, etc.
5816
5817 *'shortmess'* *'shm'*
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00005818'shortmess' 'shm' string (Vim default "filnxtToO", Vi default: "",
5819 POSIX default: "A")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005820 global
5821 {not in Vi}
5822 This option helps to avoid all the |hit-enter| prompts caused by file
5823 messages, for example with CTRL-G, and to avoid some other messages.
5824 It is a list of flags:
5825 flag meaning when present ~
5826 f use "(3 of 5)" instead of "(file 3 of 5)"
5827 i use "[noeol]" instead of "[Incomplete last line]"
5828 l use "999L, 888C" instead of "999 lines, 888 characters"
5829 m use "[+]" instead of "[Modified]"
5830 n use "[New]" instead of "[New File]"
5831 r use "[RO]" instead of "[readonly]"
5832 w use "[w]" instead of "written" for file write message
5833 and "[a]" instead of "appended" for ':w >> file' command
5834 x use "[dos]" instead of "[dos format]", "[unix]" instead of
5835 "[unix format]" and "[mac]" instead of "[mac format]".
5836 a all of the above abbreviations
5837
5838 o overwrite message for writing a file with subsequent message
5839 for reading a file (useful for ":wn" or when 'autowrite' on)
5840 O message for reading a file overwrites any previous message.
5841 Also for quickfix message (e.g., ":cn").
5842 s don't give "search hit BOTTOM, continuing at TOP" or "search
5843 hit TOP, continuing at BOTTOM" messages
5844 t truncate file message at the start if it is too long to fit
5845 on the command-line, "<" will appear in the left most column.
5846 Ignored in Ex mode.
5847 T truncate other messages in the middle if they are too long to
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00005848 fit on the command line. "..." will appear in the middle.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005849 Ignored in Ex mode.
5850 W don't give "written" or "[w]" when writing a file
5851 A don't give the "ATTENTION" message when an existing swap file
5852 is found.
5853 I don't give the intro message when starting Vim |:intro|.
5854
5855 This gives you the opportunity to avoid that a change between buffers
5856 requires you to hit <Enter>, but still gives as useful a message as
5857 possible for the space available. To get the whole message that you
5858 would have got with 'shm' empty, use ":file!"
5859 Useful values:
5860 shm= No abbreviation of message.
5861 shm=a Abbreviation, but no loss of information.
5862 shm=at Abbreviation, and truncate message when necessary.
5863
5864 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
5865 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
5866
5867 *'shortname'* *'sn'* *'noshortname'* *'nosn'*
5868'shortname' 'sn' boolean (default off)
5869 local to buffer
5870 {not in Vi, not in MS-DOS versions}
5871 Filenames are assumed to be 8 characters plus one extension of 3
5872 characters. Multiple dots in file names are not allowed. When this
5873 option is on, dots in file names are replaced with underscores when
5874 adding an extension (".~" or ".swp"). This option is not available
5875 for MS-DOS, because then it would always be on. This option is useful
5876 when editing files on an MS-DOS compatible filesystem, e.g., messydos
5877 or crossdos. When running the Win32 GUI version under Win32s, this
5878 option is always on by default.
5879
5880 *'showbreak'* *'sbr'* *E595*
5881'showbreak' 'sbr' string (default "")
5882 global
5883 {not in Vi}
5884 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
5885 feature}
5886 String to put at the start of lines that have been wrapped. Useful
5887 values are "> " or "+++ ".
5888 Only printable single-cell characters are allowed, excluding <Tab> and
5889 comma (in a future version the comma might be used to separate the
5890 part that is shown at the end and at the start of a line).
5891 The characters are highlighted according to the '@' flag in
5892 'highlight'.
5893 Note that tabs after the showbreak will be displayed differently.
5894 If you want the 'showbreak' to appear in between line numbers, add the
5895 "n" flag to 'cpoptions'.
5896
5897 *'showcmd'* *'sc'* *'noshowcmd'* *'nosc'*
5898'showcmd' 'sc' boolean (Vim default: on, off for Unix, Vi default:
5899 off)
5900 global
5901 {not in Vi}
5902 {not available when compiled without the
5903 |+cmdline_info| feature}
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005904 Show (partial) command in the last line of the screen. Set this
5905 option off if your terminal is slow.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005906 In Visual mode the size of the selected area is shown:
5907 - When selecting characters within a line, the number of characters.
5908 - When selecting more than one line, the number of lines.
5909 - When selecting a block, the size in screen characters: linesxcolumns.
5910 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
5911 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
5912
5913 *'showfulltag'* *'sft'* *'noshowfulltag'* *'nosft'*
5914'showfulltag' 'sft' boolean (default off)
5915 global
5916 {not in Vi}
5917 When completing a word in insert mode (see |ins-completion|) from the
5918 tags file, show both the tag name and a tidied-up form of the search
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005919 pattern (if there is one) as possible matches. Thus, if you have
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005920 matched a C function, you can see a template for what arguments are
5921 required (coding style permitting).
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00005922 Note that this doesn't work well together with having "longest" in
5923 'completeopt', because the completion from the search pattern may not
5924 match the typed text.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005925
5926 *'showmatch'* *'sm'* *'noshowmatch'* *'nosm'*
5927'showmatch' 'sm' boolean (default off)
5928 global
5929 When a bracket is inserted, briefly jump to the matching one. The
5930 jump is only done if the match can be seen on the screen. The time to
5931 show the match can be set with 'matchtime'.
5932 A Beep is given if there is no match (no matter if the match can be
5933 seen or not). This option is reset when the 'paste' option is set.
5934 When the 'm' flag is not included in 'cpoptions', typing a character
5935 will immediately move the cursor back to where it belongs.
5936 See the "sm" field in 'guicursor' for setting the cursor shape and
5937 blinking when showing the match.
5938 The 'matchpairs' option can be used to specify the characters to show
5939 matches for. 'rightleft' and 'revins' are used to look for opposite
5940 matches.
Bram Moolenaarfd2ac762006-03-01 22:09:21 +00005941 Also see the matchparen plugin for highlighting the match when moving
5942 around |pi_paren.txt|.
5943 Note: Use of the short form is rated PG.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005944
5945 *'showmode'* *'smd'* *'noshowmode'* *'nosmd'*
5946'showmode' 'smd' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
5947 global
5948 If in Insert, Replace or Visual mode put a message on the last line.
5949 Use the 'M' flag in 'highlight' to set the type of highlighting for
5950 this message.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005951 When |XIM| may be used the message will include "XIM". But this
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005952 doesn't mean XIM is really active, especially when 'imactivatekey' is
5953 not set.
5954 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
5955 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
5956
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00005957 *'showtabline'* *'stal'*
5958'showtabline' 'stal' number (default 1)
5959 global
5960 {not in Vi}
5961 {not available when compiled without the +windows
5962 feature}
5963 The value of this option specifies when the line with tab page labels
5964 will be displayed:
5965 0: never
5966 1: only if there are at least two tab pages
5967 2: always
5968 This is both for the GUI and non-GUI implementation of the tab pages
5969 line.
5970 See |tab-page| for more information about tab pages.
5971
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005972 *'sidescroll'* *'ss'*
5973'sidescroll' 'ss' number (default 0)
5974 global
5975 {not in Vi}
5976 The minimal number of columns to scroll horizontally. Used only when
5977 the 'wrap' option is off and the cursor is moved off of the screen.
5978 When it is zero the cursor will be put in the middle of the screen.
5979 When using a slow terminal set it to a large number or 0. When using
5980 a fast terminal use a small number or 1. Not used for "zh" and "zl"
5981 commands.
5982
5983 *'sidescrolloff'* *'siso'*
5984'sidescrolloff' 'siso' number (default 0)
5985 global
5986 {not in Vi}
5987 The minimal number of screen columns to keep to the left and to the
Bram Moolenaar482aaeb2005-09-29 18:26:07 +00005988 right of the cursor if 'nowrap' is set. Setting this option to a
5989 value greater than 0 while having |'sidescroll'| also at a non-zero
5990 value makes some context visible in the line you are scrolling in
5991 horizontally (except at beginning of the line). Setting this option
5992 to a large value (like 999) has the effect of keeping the cursor
5993 horizontally centered in the window, as long as one does not come too
5994 close to the beginning of the line.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005995 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
5996
5997 Example: Try this together with 'sidescroll' and 'listchars' as
5998 in the following example to never allow the cursor to move
5999 onto the "extends" character:
6000
6001 :set nowrap sidescroll=1 listchars=extends:>,precedes:<
6002 :set sidescrolloff=1
6003
6004
6005 *'smartcase'* *'scs'* *'nosmartcase'* *'noscs'*
6006'smartcase' 'scs' boolean (default off)
6007 global
6008 {not in Vi}
6009 Override the 'ignorecase' option if the search pattern contains upper
6010 case characters. Only used when the search pattern is typed and
6011 'ignorecase' option is on. Used for the commands "/", "?", "n", "N",
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006012 ":g" and ":s". Not used for "*", "#", "gd", tag search, etc.. After
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006013 "*" and "#" you can make 'smartcase' used by doing a "/" command,
6014 recalling the search pattern from history and hitting <Enter>.
6015 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
6016
6017 *'smartindent'* *'si'* *'nosmartindent'* *'nosi'*
6018'smartindent' 'si' boolean (default off)
6019 local to buffer
6020 {not in Vi}
6021 {not available when compiled without the
6022 |+smartindent| feature}
6023 Do smart autoindenting when starting a new line. Works for C-like
6024 programs, but can also be used for other languages. 'cindent' does
6025 something like this, works better in most cases, but is more strict,
6026 see |C-indenting|. When 'cindent' is on, setting 'si' has no effect.
6027 'indentexpr' is a more advanced alternative.
6028 Normally 'autoindent' should also be on when using 'smartindent'.
6029 An indent is automatically inserted:
6030 - After a line ending in '{'.
6031 - After a line starting with a keyword from 'cinwords'.
6032 - Before a line starting with '}' (only with the "O" command).
6033 When typing '}' as the first character in a new line, that line is
6034 given the same indent as the matching '{'.
6035 When typing '#' as the first character in a new line, the indent for
6036 that line is removed, the '#' is put in the first column. The indent
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006037 is restored for the next line. If you don't want this, use this
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006038 mapping: ":inoremap # X^H#", where ^H is entered with CTRL-V CTRL-H.
6039 When using the ">>" command, lines starting with '#' are not shifted
6040 right.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006041 NOTE: 'smartindent' is reset when 'compatible' is set. When 'paste'
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006042 is set smart indenting is disabled.
6043
6044 *'smarttab'* *'sta'* *'nosmarttab'* *'nosta'*
6045'smarttab' 'sta' boolean (default off)
6046 global
6047 {not in Vi}
6048 When on, a <Tab> in front of a line inserts blanks according to
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00006049 'shiftwidth'. 'tabstop' or 'softtabstop' is used in other places. A
6050 <BS> will delete a 'shiftwidth' worth of space at the start of the
6051 line.
Bram Moolenaarafeb4fa2006-02-01 21:51:12 +00006052 When off, a <Tab> always inserts blanks according to 'tabstop' or
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00006053 'softtabstop'. 'shiftwidth' is only used for shifting text left or
6054 right |shift-left-right|.
Bram Moolenaarebcbd022007-05-12 14:28:25 +00006055 What gets inserted (a <Tab> or spaces) depends on the 'expandtab'
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006056 option. Also see |ins-expandtab|. When 'expandtab' is not set, the
Bram Moolenaar843ee412004-06-30 16:16:41 +00006057 number of spaces is minimized by using <Tab>s.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006058 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
6059
6060 *'softtabstop'* *'sts'*
6061'softtabstop' 'sts' number (default 0)
6062 local to buffer
6063 {not in Vi}
6064 Number of spaces that a <Tab> counts for while performing editing
6065 operations, like inserting a <Tab> or using <BS>. It "feels" like
6066 <Tab>s are being inserted, while in fact a mix of spaces and <Tab>s is
6067 used. This is useful to keep the 'ts' setting at its standard value
6068 of 8, while being able to edit like it is set to 'sts'. However,
6069 commands like "x" still work on the actual characters.
6070 When 'sts' is zero, this feature is off.
6071 'softtabstop' is set to 0 when the 'paste' option is set.
6072 See also |ins-expandtab|. When 'expandtab' is not set, the number of
6073 spaces is minimized by using <Tab>s.
6074 The 'L' flag in 'cpoptions' changes how tabs are used when 'list' is
6075 set.
6076 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
6077
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00006078 *'spell'* *'nospell'*
6079'spell' boolean (default off)
6080 local to window
6081 {not in Vi}
6082 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
6083 feature}
6084 When on spell checking will be done. See |spell|.
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00006085 The languages are specified with 'spelllang'.
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00006086
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00006087 *'spellcapcheck'* *'spc'*
Bram Moolenaar0dc065e2005-07-04 22:49:24 +00006088'spellcapcheck' 'spc' string (default "[.?!]\_[\])'" \t]\+")
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00006089 local to buffer
6090 {not in Vi}
6091 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
6092 feature}
6093 Pattern to locate the end of a sentence. The following word will be
6094 checked to start with a capital letter. If not then it is highlighted
Bram Moolenaar8aff23a2005-08-19 20:40:30 +00006095 with SpellCap |hl-SpellCap| (unless the word is also badly spelled).
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00006096 When this check is not wanted make this option empty.
6097 Only used when 'spell' is set.
Bram Moolenaar0dc065e2005-07-04 22:49:24 +00006098 Be careful with special characters, see |option-backslash| about
6099 including spaces and backslashes.
Bram Moolenaar90cfdbe2005-08-12 19:59:19 +00006100 To set this option automatically depending on the language, see
6101 |set-spc-auto|.
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00006102
Bram Moolenaar82cf9b62005-06-07 21:09:25 +00006103 *'spellfile'* *'spf'*
6104'spellfile' 'spf' string (default empty)
6105 local to buffer
6106 {not in Vi}
6107 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
6108 feature}
6109 Name of the word list file where words are added for the |zg| and |zw|
Bram Moolenaar045e82d2005-07-08 22:25:33 +00006110 commands. It must end in ".{encoding}.add". You need to include the
6111 path, otherwise the file is placed in the current directory.
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00006112 *E765*
6113 It may also be a comma separated list of names. A count before the
6114 |zg| and |zw| commands can be used to access each. This allows using
6115 a personal word list file and a project word list file.
Bram Moolenaar82cf9b62005-06-07 21:09:25 +00006116 When a word is added while this option is empty Vim will set it for
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00006117 you: Using the first directory in 'runtimepath' that is writable. If
6118 there is no "spell" directory yet it will be created. For the file
6119 name the first language name that appears in 'spelllang' is used,
Bram Moolenaar3b506942005-06-23 22:36:45 +00006120 ignoring the region.
6121 The resulting ".spl" file will be used for spell checking, it does not
6122 have to appear in 'spelllang'.
6123 Normally one file is used for all regions, but you can add the region
6124 name if you want to. However, it will then only be used when
6125 'spellfile' is set to it, for entries in 'spelllang' only files
6126 without region name will be found.
Bram Moolenaare7566042005-06-17 22:00:15 +00006127 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6128 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar82cf9b62005-06-07 21:09:25 +00006129
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00006130 *'spelllang'* *'spl'*
Bram Moolenaar82cf9b62005-06-07 21:09:25 +00006131'spelllang' 'spl' string (default "en")
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00006132 local to buffer
6133 {not in Vi}
6134 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
6135 feature}
Bram Moolenaar3b506942005-06-23 22:36:45 +00006136 A comma separated list of word list names. When the 'spell' option is
6137 on spellchecking will be done for these languages. Example: >
6138 set spelllang=en_us,nl,medical
6139< This means US English, Dutch and medical words are recognized. Words
6140 that are not recognized will be highlighted.
6141 The word list name must not include a comma or dot. Using a dash is
6142 recommended to separate the two letter language name from a
6143 specification. Thus "en-rare" is used for rare English words.
6144 A region name must come last and have the form "_xx", where "xx" is
6145 the two-letter, lower case region name. You can use more than one
6146 region by listing them: "en_us,en_ca" supports both US and Canadian
6147 English, but not words specific for Australia, New Zealand or Great
6148 Britain.
Bram Moolenaar8aff23a2005-08-19 20:40:30 +00006149 *E757*
Bram Moolenaarce0842a2005-07-18 21:58:11 +00006150 As a special case the name of a .spl file can be given as-is. The
6151 first "_xx" in the name is removed and used as the region name
6152 (_xx is an underscore, two letters and followed by a non-letter).
6153 This is mainly for testing purposes. You must make sure the correct
6154 encoding is used, Vim doesn't check it.
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00006155 When 'encoding' is set the word lists are reloaded. Thus it's a good
Bram Moolenaarce0842a2005-07-18 21:58:11 +00006156 idea to set 'spelllang' after setting 'encoding' to avoid loading the
6157 files twice.
Bram Moolenaar3b506942005-06-23 22:36:45 +00006158 How the related spell files are found is explained here: |spell-load|.
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00006159
Bram Moolenaar98692072006-02-04 00:57:42 +00006160 If the |spellfile.vim| plugin is active and you use a language name
6161 for which Vim cannot find the .spl file in 'runtimepath' the plugin
6162 will ask you if you want to download the file.
6163
Bram Moolenaar90cfdbe2005-08-12 19:59:19 +00006164 After this option has been set successfully, Vim will source the files
6165 "spell/LANG.vim" in 'runtimepath'. "LANG" is the value of 'spelllang'
Bram Moolenaarafeb4fa2006-02-01 21:51:12 +00006166 up to the first comma, dot or underscore.
6167 Also see |set-spc-auto|.
Bram Moolenaar90cfdbe2005-08-12 19:59:19 +00006168
6169
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00006170 *'spellsuggest'* *'sps'*
6171'spellsuggest' 'sps' string (default "best")
6172 global
6173 {not in Vi}
6174 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
6175 feature}
Bram Moolenaar2c7a29c2005-12-12 22:02:31 +00006176 Methods used for spelling suggestions. Both for the |z=| command and
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00006177 the |spellsuggest()| function. This is a comma-separated list of
6178 items:
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00006179
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00006180 best Internal method that works best for English. Finds
6181 changes like "fast" and uses a bit of sound-a-like
6182 scoring to improve the ordering.
6183
6184 double Internal method that uses two methods and mixes the
6185 results. The first method is "fast", the other method
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00006186 computes how much the suggestion sounds like the bad
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00006187 word. That only works when the language specifies
6188 sound folding. Can be slow and doesn't always give
6189 better results.
6190
6191 fast Internal method that only checks for simple changes:
6192 character inserts/deletes/swaps. Works well for
6193 simple typing mistakes.
6194
Bram Moolenaar2c7a29c2005-12-12 22:02:31 +00006195 {number} The maximum number of suggestions listed for |z=|.
Bram Moolenaar8aff23a2005-08-19 20:40:30 +00006196 Not used for |spellsuggest()|. The number of
6197 suggestions is never more than the value of 'lines'
6198 minus two.
6199
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00006200 file:{filename} Read file {filename}, which must have two columns,
6201 separated by a slash. The first column contains the
6202 bad word, the second column the suggested good word.
6203 Example:
6204 theribal/terrible ~
6205 Use this for common mistakes that do not appear at the
6206 top of the suggestion list with the internal methods.
6207 Lines without a slash are ignored, use this for
6208 comments.
6209 The file is used for all languages.
6210
6211 expr:{expr} Evaluate expression {expr}. Use a function to avoid
6212 trouble with spaces. |v:val| holds the badly spelled
6213 word. The expression must evaluate to a List of
6214 Lists, each with a suggestion and a score.
6215 Example:
6216 [['the', 33], ['that', 44]]
Bram Moolenaar2c7a29c2005-12-12 22:02:31 +00006217 Set 'verbose' and use |z=| to see the scores that the
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00006218 internal methods use. A lower score is better.
6219 This may invoke |spellsuggest()| if you temporarily
6220 set 'spellsuggest' to exclude the "expr:" part.
6221 Errors are silently ignored, unless you set the
6222 'verbose' option to a non-zero value.
6223
6224 Only one of "best", "double" or "fast" may be used. The others may
6225 appear several times in any order. Example: >
6226 :set sps=file:~/.vim/sugg,best,expr:MySuggest()
6227<
6228 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6229 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00006230
6231
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006232 *'splitbelow'* *'sb'* *'nosplitbelow'* *'nosb'*
6233'splitbelow' 'sb' boolean (default off)
6234 global
6235 {not in Vi}
6236 {not available when compiled without the +windows
6237 feature}
6238 When on, splitting a window will put the new window below the current
6239 one. |:split|
6240
6241 *'splitright'* *'spr'* *'nosplitright'* *'nospr'*
6242'splitright' 'spr' boolean (default off)
6243 global
6244 {not in Vi}
6245 {not available when compiled without the +vertsplit
6246 feature}
6247 When on, splitting a window will put the new window right of the
6248 current one. |:vsplit|
6249
6250 *'startofline'* *'sol'* *'nostartofline'* *'nosol'*
6251'startofline' 'sol' boolean (default on)
6252 global
6253 {not in Vi}
6254 When "on" the commands listed below move the cursor to the first
Bram Moolenaar843ee412004-06-30 16:16:41 +00006255 non-blank of the line. When off the cursor is kept in the same column
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006256 (if possible). This applies to the commands: CTRL-D, CTRL-U, CTRL-B,
Bram Moolenaar843ee412004-06-30 16:16:41 +00006257 CTRL-F, "G", "H", "M", "L", gg, and to the commands "d", "<<" and ">>"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006258 with a linewise operator, with "%" with a count and to buffer changing
6259 commands (CTRL-^, :bnext, :bNext, etc.). Also for an Ex command that
6260 only has a line number, e.g., ":25" or ":+".
6261 In case of buffer changing commands the cursor is placed at the column
6262 where it was the last time the buffer was edited.
6263 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set.
6264
6265 *'statusline'* *'stl'* *E540* *E541* *E542*
6266'statusline' 'stl' string (default empty)
Bram Moolenaarb5bf5b82004-12-24 14:35:23 +00006267 global or local to window |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006268 {not in Vi}
6269 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline|
6270 feature}
6271 When nonempty, this option determines the content of the status line.
6272 Also see |status-line|.
6273
6274 The option consists of printf style '%' items interspersed with
6275 normal text. Each status line item is of the form:
6276 %-0{minwid}.{maxwid}{item}
6277 All fields except the {item} is optional. A single percent sign can
6278 be given as "%%". Up to 80 items can be specified.
6279
Bram Moolenaar238a5642006-02-21 22:12:05 +00006280 When the option starts with "%!" then it is used as an expression,
6281 evaluated and the result is used as the option value. Example: >
6282 :set statusline=%!MyStatusLine()
6283< The result can contain %{} items that will be evaluated too.
6284
6285 When there is error while evaluating the option then it will be made
6286 empty to avoid further errors. Otherwise screen updating would loop.
6287
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006288 Note that the only effect of 'ruler' when this option is set (and
6289 'laststatus' is 2) is controlling the output of |CTRL-G|.
6290
6291 field meaning ~
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00006292 - Left justify the item. The default is right justified
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006293 when minwid is larger than the length of the item.
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00006294 0 Leading zeroes in numeric items. Overridden by '-'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006295 minwid Minimum width of the item, padding as set by '-' & '0'.
6296 Value must be 50 or less.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006297 maxwid Maximum width of the item. Truncation occurs with a '<'
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006298 on the left for text items. Numeric items will be
6299 shifted down to maxwid-2 digits followed by '>'number
6300 where number is the amount of missing digits, much like
6301 an exponential notation.
6302 item A one letter code as described below.
6303
6304 Following is a description of the possible statusline items. The
6305 second character in "item" is the type:
6306 N for number
6307 S for string
6308 F for flags as described below
6309 - not applicable
6310
6311 item meaning ~
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00006312 f S Path to the file in the buffer, as typed or relative to current
6313 directory.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006314 F S Full path to the file in the buffer.
6315 t S File name (tail) of file in the buffer.
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00006316 m F Modified flag, text is "[+]"; "[-]" if 'modifiable' is off.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006317 M F Modified flag, text is ",+" or ",-".
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00006318 r F Readonly flag, text is "[RO]".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006319 R F Readonly flag, text is ",RO".
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00006320 h F Help buffer flag, text is "[help]".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006321 H F Help buffer flag, text is ",HLP".
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00006322 w F Preview window flag, text is "[Preview]".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006323 W F Preview window flag, text is ",PRV".
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00006324 y F Type of file in the buffer, e.g., "[vim]". See 'filetype'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006325 Y F Type of file in the buffer, e.g., ",VIM". See 'filetype'.
6326 {not available when compiled without |+autocmd| feature}
6327 k S Value of "b:keymap_name" or 'keymap' when |:lmap| mappings are
6328 being used: "<keymap>"
6329 n N Buffer number.
6330 b N Value of byte under cursor.
6331 B N As above, in hexadecimal.
6332 o N Byte number in file of byte under cursor, first byte is 1.
6333 Mnemonic: Offset from start of file (with one added)
6334 {not available when compiled without |+byte_offset| feature}
6335 O N As above, in hexadecimal.
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00006336 N N Printer page number. (Only works in the 'printheader' option.)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006337 l N Line number.
6338 L N Number of lines in buffer.
6339 c N Column number.
6340 v N Virtual column number.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006341 V N Virtual column number as -{num}. Not displayed if equal to 'c'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006342 p N Percentage through file in lines as in |CTRL-G|.
6343 P S Percentage through file of displayed window. This is like the
6344 percentage described for 'ruler'. Always 3 in length.
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00006345 a S Argument list status as in default title. ({current} of {max})
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006346 Empty if the argument file count is zero or one.
Bram Moolenaar238a5642006-02-21 22:12:05 +00006347 { NF Evaluate expression between '%{' and '}' and substitute result.
Bram Moolenaar4770d092006-01-12 23:22:24 +00006348 Note that there is no '%' before the closing '}'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006349 ( - Start of item group. Can be used for setting the width and
6350 alignment of a section. Must be followed by %) somewhere.
6351 ) - End of item group. No width fields allowed.
Bram Moolenaard1f56e62006-02-22 21:25:37 +00006352 T N For 'tabline': start of tab page N label. Use %T after the last
6353 label. This information is used for mouse clicks.
6354 X N For 'tabline': start of close tab N label. Use %X after the
6355 label, e.g.: %3Xclose%X. Use %999X for a "close current tab"
6356 mark. This information is used for mouse clicks.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006357 < - Where to truncate line if too long. Default is at the start.
6358 No width fields allowed.
6359 = - Separation point between left and right aligned items.
6360 No width fields allowed.
Bram Moolenaar238a5642006-02-21 22:12:05 +00006361 # - Set highlight group. The name must follow and then a # again.
6362 Thus use %#HLname# for highlight group HLname. The same
6363 highlighting is used, also for the statusline of non-current
6364 windows.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006365 * - Set highlight group to User{N}, where {N} is taken from the
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00006366 minwid field, e.g. %1*. Restore normal highlight with %* or %0*.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006367 The difference between User{N} and StatusLine will be applied
6368 to StatusLineNC for the statusline of non-current windows.
6369 The number N must be between 1 and 9. See |hl-User1..9|
6370
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00006371 When displaying a flag, Vim removes the leading comma, if any, when
6372 that flag comes right after plaintext. This will make a nice display
6373 when flags are used like in the examples below.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006374
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00006375 When all items in a group becomes an empty string (i.e. flags that are
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006376 not set) and a minwid is not set for the group, the whole group will
6377 become empty. This will make a group like the following disappear
6378 completely from the statusline when none of the flags are set. >
6379 :set statusline=...%(\ [%M%R%H]%)...
6380<
6381 Beware that an expression is evaluated each and every time the status
6382 line is displayed. The current buffer and current window will be set
6383 temporarily to that of the window (and buffer) whose statusline is
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00006384 currently being drawn. The expression will evaluate in this context.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006385 The variable "actual_curbuf" is set to the 'bufnr()' number of the
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00006386 real current buffer.
6387
6388 The 'statusline' option may be evaluated in the |sandbox|, see
6389 |sandbox-option|.
6390
6391 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
6392 evaluating 'statusline' |textlock|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006393
6394 If the statusline is not updated when you want it (e.g., after setting
6395 a variable that's used in an expression), you can force an update by
6396 setting an option without changing its value. Example: >
6397 :let &ro = &ro
6398
6399< A result of all digits is regarded a number for display purposes.
6400 Otherwise the result is taken as flag text and applied to the rules
6401 described above.
6402
Bram Moolenaarcd71fa32005-03-11 22:46:48 +00006403 Watch out for errors in expressions. They may render Vim unusable!
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006404 If you are stuck, hold down ':' or 'Q' to get a prompt, then quit and
6405 edit your .vimrc or whatever with "vim -u NONE" to get it right.
6406
6407 Examples:
6408 Emulate standard status line with 'ruler' set >
6409 :set statusline=%<%f\ %h%m%r%=%-14.(%l,%c%V%)\ %P
6410< Similar, but add ASCII value of char under the cursor (like "ga") >
6411 :set statusline=%<%f%h%m%r%=%b\ 0x%B\ \ %l,%c%V\ %P
6412< Display byte count and byte value, modified flag in red. >
6413 :set statusline=%<%f%=\ [%1*%M%*%n%R%H]\ %-19(%3l,%02c%03V%)%O'%02b'
6414 :hi User1 term=inverse,bold cterm=inverse,bold ctermfg=red
6415< Display a ,GZ flag if a compressed file is loaded >
6416 :set statusline=...%r%{VarExists('b:gzflag','\ [GZ]')}%h...
6417< In the |:autocmd|'s: >
6418 :let b:gzflag = 1
6419< And: >
6420 :unlet b:gzflag
6421< And define this function: >
6422 :function VarExists(var, val)
6423 : if exists(a:var) | return a:val | else | return '' | endif
6424 :endfunction
6425<
6426 *'suffixes'* *'su'*
6427'suffixes' 'su' string (default ".bak,~,.o,.h,.info,.swp,.obj")
6428 global
6429 {not in Vi}
6430 Files with these suffixes get a lower priority when multiple files
6431 match a wildcard. See |suffixes|. Commas can be used to separate the
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006432 suffixes. Spaces after the comma are ignored. A dot is also seen as
6433 the start of a suffix. To avoid a dot or comma being recognized as a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006434 separator, precede it with a backslash (see |option-backslash| about
6435 including spaces and backslashes).
6436 See 'wildignore' for completely ignoring files.
6437 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
6438 suffixes from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
6439 uses another default.
6440
6441 *'suffixesadd'* *'sua'*
6442'suffixesadd' 'sua' string (default "")
6443 local to buffer
6444 {not in Vi}
6445 {not available when compiled without the
6446 |+file_in_path| feature}
6447 Comma separated list of suffixes, which are used when searching for a
6448 file for the "gf", "[I", etc. commands. Example: >
6449 :set suffixesadd=.java
6450<
6451 *'swapfile'* *'swf'* *'noswapfile'* *'noswf'*
6452'swapfile' 'swf' boolean (default on)
6453 local to buffer
6454 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006455 Use a swapfile for the buffer. This option can be reset when a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006456 swapfile is not wanted for a specific buffer. For example, with
6457 confidential information that even root must not be able to access.
6458 Careful: All text will be in memory:
6459 - Don't use this for big files.
6460 - Recovery will be impossible!
6461 A swapfile will only be present when |'updatecount'| is non-zero and
6462 'swapfile' is set.
6463 When 'swapfile' is reset, the swap file for the current buffer is
6464 immediately deleted. When 'swapfile' is set, and 'updatecount' is
6465 non-zero, a swap file is immediately created.
6466 Also see |swap-file| and |'swapsync'|.
6467
6468 This option is used together with 'bufhidden' and 'buftype' to
6469 specify special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|.
6470
6471 *'swapsync'* *'sws'*
6472'swapsync' 'sws' string (default "fsync")
6473 global
6474 {not in Vi}
6475 When this option is not empty a swap file is synced to disk after
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006476 writing to it. This takes some time, especially on busy unix systems.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006477 When this option is empty parts of the swap file may be in memory and
6478 not written to disk. When the system crashes you may lose more work.
6479 On Unix the system does a sync now and then without Vim asking for it,
6480 so the disadvantage of setting this option off is small. On some
6481 systems the swap file will not be written at all. For a unix system
6482 setting it to "sync" will use the sync() call instead of the default
6483 fsync(), which may work better on some systems.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00006484 The 'fsync' option is used for the actual file.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006485
6486 *'switchbuf'* *'swb'*
6487'switchbuf' 'swb' string (default "")
6488 global
6489 {not in Vi}
6490 This option controls the behavior when switching between buffers.
6491 Possible values (comma separated list):
6492 useopen If included, jump to the first open window that
6493 contains the specified buffer (if there is one).
6494 Otherwise: Do not examine other windows.
6495 This setting is checked with |quickfix| commands, when
6496 jumping to errors (":cc", ":cn", "cp", etc.). It is
6497 also used in all buffer related split commands, for
6498 example ":sbuffer", ":sbnext", or ":sbrewind".
Bram Moolenaar779b74b2006-04-10 14:55:34 +00006499 usetab Like "useopen", but also consider windows in other tab
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00006500 pages.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006501 split If included, split the current window before loading
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00006502 a buffer. Otherwise: do not split, use current window.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006503 Supported in |quickfix| commands that display errors.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00006504 newtab Like "split", but open a new tab page. Overrules
6505 "split" when both are present.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006506
Bram Moolenaar3b56eb32005-07-11 22:40:32 +00006507 *'synmaxcol'* *'smc'*
6508'synmaxcol' 'smc' number (default 3000)
6509 local to buffer
6510 {not in Vi}
6511 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
6512 feature}
Bram Moolenaarce0842a2005-07-18 21:58:11 +00006513 Maximum column in which to search for syntax items. In long lines the
6514 text after this column is not highlighted and following lines may not
6515 be highlighted correctly, because the syntax state is cleared.
Bram Moolenaar3b56eb32005-07-11 22:40:32 +00006516 This helps to avoid very slow redrawing for an XML file that is one
6517 long line.
6518 Set to zero to remove the limit.
6519
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006520 *'syntax'* *'syn'*
6521'syntax' 'syn' string (default empty)
6522 local to buffer
6523 {not in Vi}
6524 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
6525 feature}
6526 When this option is set, the syntax with this name is loaded, unless
6527 syntax highlighting has been switched off with ":syntax off".
6528 Otherwise this option does not always reflect the current syntax (the
6529 b:current_syntax variable does).
6530 This option is most useful in a modeline, for a file which syntax is
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00006531 not automatically recognized. Example, in an IDL file:
6532 /* vim: set syntax=idl : */ ~
6533 When a dot appears in the value then this separates two filetype
6534 names. Example:
6535 /* vim: set syntax=c.doxygen : */ ~
6536 This will use the "c" syntax first, then the "doxygen" syntax.
6537 Note that the second one must be prepared to be loaded as an addition,
6538 otherwise it will be skipped. More than one dot may appear.
6539 To switch off syntax highlighting for the current file, use: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006540 :set syntax=OFF
6541< To switch syntax highlighting on according to the current value of the
6542 'filetype' option: >
6543 :set syntax=ON
6544< What actually happens when setting the 'syntax' option is that the
6545 Syntax autocommand event is triggered with the value as argument.
6546 This option is not copied to another buffer, independent of the 's' or
6547 'S' flag in 'cpoptions'.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00006548 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006549
Bram Moolenaarfd2ac762006-03-01 22:09:21 +00006550 *'tabline'* *'tal'*
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00006551'tabline' 'tal' string (default empty)
Bram Moolenaar7e8fd632006-02-18 22:14:51 +00006552 global
6553 {not in Vi}
6554 {not available when compiled without the +windows
6555 feature}
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00006556 When nonempty, this option determines the content of the tab pages
6557 line at the top of the Vim window. When empty Vim will use a default
Bram Moolenaard1f56e62006-02-22 21:25:37 +00006558 tab pages line. See |setting-tabline| for more info.
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00006559
6560 The tab pages line only appears as specified with the 'showtabline'
Bram Moolenaar5c8837f2006-02-25 21:52:33 +00006561 option and only when there is no GUI tab line. When 'e' is in
6562 'guioptions' and the GUI supports a tab line 'guitablabel' is used
6563 instead.
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00006564
6565 The value is evaluated like with 'statusline'. You can use
6566 |tabpagenr()|, |tabpagewinnr()| and |tabpagebuflist()| to figure out
Bram Moolenaard1f56e62006-02-22 21:25:37 +00006567 the text to be displayed. Use "%1T" for the first label, "%2T" for
6568 the second one, etc. Use "%X" items for closing labels.
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00006569
6570 Keep in mind that only one of the tab pages is the current one, others
6571 are invisible and you can't jump to their windows.
6572
Bram Moolenaar7e8fd632006-02-18 22:14:51 +00006573
Bram Moolenaarfd2ac762006-03-01 22:09:21 +00006574 *'tabpagemax'* *'tpm'*
6575'tabpagemax' 'tpm' number (default 10)
6576 global
6577 {not in Vi}
6578 {not available when compiled without the +windows
6579 feature}
6580 Maximum number of tab pages to be opened by the |-p| command line
6581 argument or the ":tab all" command. |tabpage|
6582
6583
6584 *'tabstop'* *'ts'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006585'tabstop' 'ts' number (default 8)
6586 local to buffer
6587 Number of spaces that a <Tab> in the file counts for. Also see
6588 |:retab| command, and 'softtabstop' option.
6589
6590 Note: Setting 'tabstop' to any other value than 8 can make your file
6591 appear wrong in many places (e.g., when printing it).
6592
6593 There are four main ways to use tabs in Vim:
6594 1. Always keep 'tabstop' at 8, set 'softtabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to 4
6595 (or 3 or whatever you prefer) and use 'noexpandtab'. Then Vim
Bram Moolenaarebcbd022007-05-12 14:28:25 +00006596 will use a mix of tabs and spaces, but typing <Tab> and <BS> will
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006597 behave like a tab appears every 4 (or 3) characters.
6598 2. Set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to whatever you prefer and use
6599 'expandtab'. This way you will always insert spaces. The
6600 formatting will never be messed up when 'tabstop' is changed.
6601 3. Set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to whatever you prefer and use a
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006602 |modeline| to set these values when editing the file again. Only
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006603 works when using Vim to edit the file.
6604 4. Always set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to the same value, and
6605 'noexpandtab'. This should then work (for initial indents only)
6606 for any tabstop setting that people use. It might be nice to have
6607 tabs after the first non-blank inserted as spaces if you do this
6608 though. Otherwise aligned comments will be wrong when 'tabstop' is
6609 changed.
6610
6611 *'tagbsearch'* *'tbs'* *'notagbsearch'* *'notbs'*
6612'tagbsearch' 'tbs' boolean (default on)
6613 global
6614 {not in Vi}
6615 When searching for a tag (e.g., for the |:ta| command), Vim can either
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006616 use a binary search or a linear search in a tags file. Binary
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006617 searching makes searching for a tag a LOT faster, but a linear search
6618 will find more tags if the tags file wasn't properly sorted.
6619 Vim normally assumes that your tags files are sorted, or indicate that
6620 they are not sorted. Only when this is not the case does the
6621 'tagbsearch' option need to be switched off.
6622
6623 When 'tagbsearch' is on, binary searching is first used in the tags
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006624 files. In certain situations, Vim will do a linear search instead for
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006625 certain files, or retry all files with a linear search. When
6626 'tagbsearch' is off, only a linear search is done.
6627
6628 Linear searching is done anyway, for one file, when Vim finds a line
6629 at the start of the file indicating that it's not sorted: >
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00006630 !_TAG_FILE_SORTED 0 /some comment/
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006631< [The whitespace before and after the '0' must be a single <Tab>]
6632
6633 When a binary search was done and no match was found in any of the
6634 files listed in 'tags', and 'ignorecase' is set or a pattern is used
6635 instead of a normal tag name, a retry is done with a linear search.
6636 Tags in unsorted tags files, and matches with different case will only
6637 be found in the retry.
6638
Bram Moolenaard4755bb2004-09-02 19:12:26 +00006639 If a tag file indicates that it is case-fold sorted, the second,
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006640 linear search can be avoided for the 'ignorecase' case. Use a value
6641 of '2' in the "!_TAG_FILE_SORTED" line for this. A tag file can be
6642 case-fold sorted with the -f switch to "sort" in most unices, as in
6643 the command: "sort -f -o tags tags". For "Exuberant ctags" version
6644 5.3 or higher the -f or --fold-case-sort switch can be used for this
6645 as well. Note that case must be folded to uppercase for this to work.
6646
6647 When 'tagbsearch' is off, tags searching is slower when a full match
6648 exists, but faster when no full match exists. Tags in unsorted tags
6649 files may only be found with 'tagbsearch' off.
6650 When the tags file is not sorted, or sorted in a wrong way (not on
6651 ASCII byte value), 'tagbsearch' should be off, or the line given above
6652 must be included in the tags file.
6653 This option doesn't affect commands that find all matching tags (e.g.,
6654 command-line completion and ":help").
6655 {Vi: always uses binary search in some versions}
6656
6657 *'taglength'* *'tl'*
6658'taglength' 'tl' number (default 0)
6659 global
6660 If non-zero, tags are significant up to this number of characters.
6661
6662 *'tagrelative'* *'tr'* *'notagrelative'* *'notr'*
6663'tagrelative' 'tr' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
6664 global
6665 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaarc6fe9192006-04-09 21:54:49 +00006666 If on and using a tags file in another directory, file names in that
6667 tags file are relative to the directory where the tags file is.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006668 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
6669 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
6670
6671 *'tags'* *'tag'* *E433*
6672'tags' 'tag' string (default "./tags,tags", when compiled with
6673 |+emacs_tags|: "./tags,./TAGS,tags,TAGS")
6674 global or local to buffer |global-local|
6675 Filenames for the tag command, separated by spaces or commas. To
6676 include a space or comma in a file name, precede it with a backslash
6677 (see |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes).
6678 When a file name starts with "./", the '.' is replaced with the path
6679 of the current file. But only when the 'd' flag is not included in
6680 'cpoptions'. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. Also see
6681 |tags-option|.
6682 "*", "**" and other wildcards can be used to search for tags files in
6683 a directory tree. See |file-searching|. {not available when compiled
6684 without the |+path_extra| feature}
Bram Moolenaare7eb9df2005-09-09 19:49:30 +00006685 The |tagfiles()| function can be used to get a list of the file names
6686 actually used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006687 If Vim was compiled with the |+emacs_tags| feature, Emacs-style tag
6688 files are also supported. They are automatically recognized. The
6689 default value becomes "./tags,./TAGS,tags,TAGS", unless case
6690 differences are ignored (MS-Windows). |emacs-tags|
6691 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
6692 file names from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
6693 uses another default.
6694 {Vi: default is "tags /usr/lib/tags"}
6695
6696 *'tagstack'* *'tgst'* *'notagstack'* *'notgst'*
6697'tagstack' 'tgst' boolean (default on)
6698 global
6699 {not in all versions of Vi}
6700 When on, the |tagstack| is used normally. When off, a ":tag" or
6701 ":tselect" command with an argument will not push the tag onto the
6702 tagstack. A following ":tag" without an argument, a ":pop" command or
6703 any other command that uses the tagstack will use the unmodified
6704 tagstack, but does change the pointer to the active entry.
6705 Resetting this option is useful when using a ":tag" command in a
6706 mapping which should not change the tagstack.
6707
6708 *'term'* *E529* *E530* *E531*
6709'term' string (default is $TERM, if that fails:
6710 in the GUI: "builtin_gui"
6711 on Amiga: "amiga"
6712 on BeOS: "beos-ansi"
6713 on Mac: "mac-ansi"
6714 on MiNT: "vt52"
6715 on MS-DOS: "pcterm"
6716 on OS/2: "os2ansi"
6717 on Unix: "ansi"
6718 on VMS: "ansi"
6719 on Win 32: "win32")
6720 global
6721 Name of the terminal. Used for choosing the terminal control
6722 characters. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
6723 For example: >
6724 :set term=$TERM
6725< See |termcap|.
6726
6727 *'termbidi'* *'tbidi'*
6728 *'notermbidi'* *'notbidi'*
6729'termbidi' 'tbidi' boolean (default off, on for "mlterm")
6730 global
6731 {not in Vi}
6732 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic|
6733 feature}
6734 The terminal is in charge of Bi-directionality of text (as specified
6735 by Unicode). The terminal is also expected to do the required shaping
6736 that some languages (such as Arabic) require.
6737 Setting this option implies that 'rightleft' will not be set when
6738 'arabic' is set and the value of 'arabicshape' will be ignored.
6739 Note that setting 'termbidi' has the immediate effect that
6740 'arabicshape' is ignored, but 'rightleft' isn't changed automatically.
6741 This option is reset when the GUI is started.
6742 For further details see |arabic.txt|.
6743
6744 *'termencoding'* *'tenc'*
6745'termencoding' 'tenc' string (default ""; with GTK+ 2 GUI: "utf-8"; with
6746 Macintosh GUI: "macroman")
6747 global
6748 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
6749 feature}
6750 {not in Vi}
6751 Encoding used for the terminal. This specifies what character
6752 encoding the keyboard produces and the display will understand. For
6753 the GUI it only applies to the keyboard ('encoding' is used for the
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00006754 display). Except for the Mac when 'macatsui' is off, then
6755 'termencoding' should be "macroman".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006756 In the Win32 console version the default value is the console codepage
6757 when it differs from the ANSI codepage.
6758 *E617*
6759 Note: This does not apply to the GTK+ 2 GUI. After the GUI has been
6760 successfully initialized, 'termencoding' is forcibly set to "utf-8".
6761 Any attempts to set a different value will be rejected, and an error
6762 message is shown.
6763 For the Win32 GUI 'termencoding' is not used for typed characters,
6764 because the Win32 system always passes Unicode characters.
6765 When empty, the same encoding is used as for the 'encoding' option.
6766 This is the normal value.
6767 Not all combinations for 'termencoding' and 'encoding' are valid. See
6768 |encoding-table|.
6769 The value for this option must be supported by internal conversions or
6770 iconv(). When this is not possible no conversion will be done and you
6771 will probably experience problems with non-ASCII characters.
6772 Example: You are working with the locale set to euc-jp (Japanese) and
6773 want to edit a UTF-8 file: >
6774 :let &termencoding = &encoding
6775 :set encoding=utf-8
6776< You need to do this when your system has no locale support for UTF-8.
6777
6778 *'terse'* *'noterse'*
6779'terse' boolean (default off)
6780 global
6781 When set: Add 's' flag to 'shortmess' option (this makes the message
6782 for a search that hits the start or end of the file not being
6783 displayed). When reset: Remove 's' flag from 'shortmess' option. {Vi
6784 shortens a lot of messages}
6785
6786 *'textauto'* *'ta'* *'notextauto'* *'nota'*
6787'textauto' 'ta' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
6788 global
6789 {not in Vi}
6790 This option is obsolete. Use 'fileformats'.
6791 For backwards compatibility, when 'textauto' is set, 'fileformats' is
6792 set to the default value for the current system. When 'textauto' is
6793 reset, 'fileformats' is made empty.
6794 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
6795 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
6796
6797 *'textmode'* *'tx'* *'notextmode'* *'notx'*
6798'textmode' 'tx' boolean (MS-DOS, Win32 and OS/2: default on,
6799 others: default off)
6800 local to buffer
6801 {not in Vi}
6802 This option is obsolete. Use 'fileformat'.
6803 For backwards compatibility, when 'textmode' is set, 'fileformat' is
6804 set to "dos". When 'textmode' is reset, 'fileformat' is set to
6805 "unix".
6806
6807 *'textwidth'* *'tw'*
6808'textwidth' 'tw' number (default 0)
6809 local to buffer
6810 {not in Vi}
6811 Maximum width of text that is being inserted. A longer line will be
6812 broken after white space to get this width. A zero value disables
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006813 this. 'textwidth' is set to 0 when the 'paste' option is set. When
6814 'textwidth' is zero, 'wrapmargin' may be used. See also
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006815 'formatoptions' and |ins-textwidth|.
Bram Moolenaarfc1421e2006-04-20 22:17:20 +00006816 When 'formatexpr' is set it will be used to break the line.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006817 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
6818
6819 *'thesaurus'* *'tsr'*
6820'thesaurus' 'tsr' string (default "")
6821 global or local to buffer |global-local|
6822 {not in Vi}
6823 List of file names, separated by commas, that are used to lookup words
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006824 for thesaurus completion commands |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-T|. Each line in
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006825 the file should contain words with similar meaning, separated by
6826 non-keyword characters (white space is preferred). Maximum line
6827 length is 510 bytes.
6828 To obtain a file to be used here, check out the wordlist FAQ at
6829 http://www.hyphenologist.co.uk .
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006830 To include a comma in a file name precede it with a backslash. Spaces
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006831 after a comma are ignored, otherwise spaces are included in the file
6832 name. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes.
6833 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
6834 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
6835 uses another default.
6836 Backticks cannot be used in this option for security reasons.
6837
6838 *'tildeop'* *'top'* *'notildeop'* *'notop'*
6839'tildeop' 'top' boolean (default off)
6840 global
6841 {not in Vi}
6842 When on: The tilde command "~" behaves like an operator.
6843 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
6844
6845 *'timeout'* *'to'* *'notimeout'* *'noto'*
6846'timeout' 'to' boolean (default on)
6847 global
6848 *'ttimeout'* *'nottimeout'*
6849'ttimeout' boolean (default off)
6850 global
6851 {not in Vi}
6852 These two options together determine the behavior when part of a
6853 mapped key sequence or keyboard code has been received:
6854
6855 'timeout' 'ttimeout' action ~
6856 off off do not time out
6857 on on or off time out on :mappings and key codes
6858 off on time out on key codes
6859
6860 If both options are off, Vim will wait until either the complete
6861 mapping or key sequence has been received, or it is clear that there
6862 is no mapping or key sequence for the received characters. For
6863 example: if you have mapped "vl" and Vim has received 'v', the next
6864 character is needed to see if the 'v' is followed by an 'l'.
6865 When one of the options is on, Vim will wait for about 1 second for
6866 the next character to arrive. After that the already received
6867 characters are interpreted as single characters. The waiting time can
6868 be changed with the 'timeoutlen' option.
6869 On slow terminals or very busy systems timing out may cause
6870 malfunctioning cursor keys. If both options are off, Vim waits
6871 forever after an entered <Esc> if there are key codes that start
6872 with <Esc>. You will have to type <Esc> twice. If you do not have
6873 problems with key codes, but would like to have :mapped key
6874 sequences not timing out in 1 second, set the 'ttimeout' option and
6875 reset the 'timeout' option.
6876
6877 NOTE: 'ttimeout' is reset when 'compatible' is set.
6878
6879 *'timeoutlen'* *'tm'*
6880'timeoutlen' 'tm' number (default 1000)
6881 global
6882 {not in all versions of Vi}
6883 *'ttimeoutlen'* *'ttm'*
6884'ttimeoutlen' 'ttm' number (default -1)
6885 global
6886 {not in Vi}
6887 The time in milliseconds that is waited for a key code or mapped key
6888 sequence to complete. Also used for CTRL-\ CTRL-N and CTRL-\ CTRL-G
6889 when part of a command has been typed.
6890 Normally only 'timeoutlen' is used and 'ttimeoutlen' is -1. When a
6891 different timeout value for key codes is desired set 'ttimeoutlen' to
6892 a non-negative number.
6893
6894 ttimeoutlen mapping delay key code delay ~
6895 < 0 'timeoutlen' 'timeoutlen'
6896 >= 0 'timeoutlen' 'ttimeoutlen'
6897
6898 The timeout only happens when the 'timeout' and 'ttimeout' options
6899 tell so. A useful setting would be >
6900 :set timeout timeoutlen=3000 ttimeoutlen=100
6901< (time out on mapping after three seconds, time out on key codes after
6902 a tenth of a second).
6903
6904 *'title'* *'notitle'*
6905'title' boolean (default off, on when title can be restored)
6906 global
6907 {not in Vi}
6908 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
6909 feature}
6910 When on, the title of the window will be set to the value of
6911 'titlestring' (if it is not empty), or to:
6912 filename [+=-] (path) - VIM
6913 Where:
6914 filename the name of the file being edited
6915 - indicates the file cannot be modified, 'ma' off
6916 + indicates the file was modified
6917 = indicates the file is read-only
6918 =+ indicates the file is read-only and modified
6919 (path) is the path of the file being edited
6920 - VIM the server name |v:servername| or "VIM"
6921 Only works if the terminal supports setting window titles
6922 (currently Amiga console, Win32 console, all GUI versions and
6923 terminals with a non- empty 't_ts' option - these are Unix xterm and
6924 iris-ansi by default, where 't_ts' is taken from the builtin termcap).
6925 *X11*
6926 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original title will
6927 be restored if possible. The output of ":version" will include "+X11"
6928 when HAVE_X11 was defined, otherwise it will be "-X11". This also
6929 works for the icon name |'icon'|.
6930 But: When Vim was started with the |-X| argument, restoring the title
6931 will not work (except in the GUI).
6932 If the title cannot be restored, it is set to the value of 'titleold'.
6933 You might want to restore the title outside of Vim then.
6934 When using an xterm from a remote machine you can use this command:
6935 rsh machine_name xterm -display $DISPLAY &
6936 then the WINDOWID environment variable should be inherited and the
6937 title of the window should change back to what it should be after
6938 exiting Vim.
6939
6940 *'titlelen'*
6941'titlelen' number (default 85)
6942 global
6943 {not in Vi}
6944 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
6945 feature}
6946 Gives the percentage of 'columns' to use for the length of the window
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006947 title. When the title is longer, only the end of the path name is
6948 shown. A '<' character before the path name is used to indicate this.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006949 Using a percentage makes this adapt to the width of the window. But
6950 it won't work perfectly, because the actual number of characters
6951 available also depends on the font used and other things in the title
6952 bar. When 'titlelen' is zero the full path is used. Otherwise,
6953 values from 1 to 30000 percent can be used.
6954 'titlelen' is also used for the 'titlestring' option.
6955
6956 *'titleold'*
6957'titleold' string (default "Thanks for flying Vim")
6958 global
6959 {not in Vi}
6960 {only available when compiled with the |+title|
6961 feature}
6962 This option will be used for the window title when exiting Vim if the
6963 original title cannot be restored. Only happens if 'title' is on or
6964 'titlestring' is not empty.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00006965 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6966 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006967 *'titlestring'*
6968'titlestring' string (default "")
6969 global
6970 {not in Vi}
6971 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
6972 feature}
6973 When this option is not empty, it will be used for the title of the
6974 window. This happens only when the 'title' option is on.
6975 Only works if the terminal supports setting window titles (currently
6976 Amiga console, Win32 console, all GUI versions and terminals with a
6977 non-empty 't_ts' option).
6978 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original title will
6979 be restored if possible |X11|.
6980 When this option contains printf-style '%' items, they will be
6981 expanded according to the rules used for 'statusline'.
6982 Example: >
6983 :auto BufEnter * let &titlestring = hostname() . "/" . expand("%:p")
6984 :set title titlestring=%<%F%=%l/%L-%P titlelen=70
6985< The value of 'titlelen' is used to align items in the middle or right
6986 of the available space.
6987 Some people prefer to have the file name first: >
6988 :set titlestring=%t%(\ %M%)%(\ (%{expand(\"%:~:.:h\")})%)%(\ %a%)
6989< Note the use of "%{ }" and an expression to get the path of the file,
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006990 without the file name. The "%( %)" constructs are used to add a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006991 separating space only when needed.
6992 NOTE: Use of special characters in 'titlestring' may cause the display
6993 to be garbled (e.g., when it contains a CR or NL character).
6994 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| feature}
6995
6996 *'toolbar'* *'tb'*
6997'toolbar' 'tb' string (default "icons,tooltips")
6998 global
6999 {only for |+GUI_GTK|, |+GUI_Athena|, |+GUI_Motif| and
7000 |+GUI_Photon|}
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007001 The contents of this option controls various toolbar settings. The
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007002 possible values are:
7003 icons Toolbar buttons are shown with icons.
7004 text Toolbar buttons shown with text.
7005 horiz Icon and text of a toolbar button are
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007006 horizontally arranged. {only in GTK+ 2 GUI}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007007 tooltips Tooltips are active for toolbar buttons.
7008 Tooltips refer to the popup help text which appears after the mouse
7009 cursor is placed over a toolbar button for a brief moment.
7010
7011 If you want the toolbar to be shown with icons as well as text, do the
7012 following: >
7013 :set tb=icons,text
7014< Motif and Athena cannot display icons and text at the same time. They
7015 will show icons if both are requested.
7016
7017 If none of the strings specified in 'toolbar' are valid or if
7018 'toolbar' is empty, this option is ignored. If you want to disable
7019 the toolbar, you need to set the 'guioptions' option. For example: >
7020 :set guioptions-=T
7021< Also see |gui-toolbar|.
7022
7023 *'toolbariconsize'* *'tbis'*
7024'toolbariconsize' 'tbis' string (default "small")
7025 global
7026 {not in Vi}
7027 {only in the GTK+ 2 GUI}
7028 Controls the size of toolbar icons. The possible values are:
7029 tiny Use tiny toolbar icons.
7030 small Use small toolbar icons (default).
7031 medium Use medium-sized toolbar icons.
7032 large Use large toolbar icons.
7033 The exact dimensions in pixels of the various icon sizes depend on
7034 the current theme. Common dimensions are large=32x32, medium=24x24,
7035 small=20x20 and tiny=16x16.
7036
7037 If 'toolbariconsize' is empty, the global default size as determined
7038 by user preferences or the current theme is used.
7039
7040 *'ttybuiltin'* *'tbi'* *'nottybuiltin'* *'notbi'*
7041'ttybuiltin' 'tbi' boolean (default on)
7042 global
7043 {not in Vi}
7044 When on, the builtin termcaps are searched before the external ones.
7045 When off the builtin termcaps are searched after the external ones.
7046 When this option is changed, you should set the 'term' option next for
7047 the change to take effect, for example: >
7048 :set notbi term=$TERM
7049< See also |termcap|.
7050 Rationale: The default for this option is "on", because the builtin
7051 termcap entries are generally better (many systems contain faulty
7052 xterm entries...).
7053
7054 *'ttyfast'* *'tf'* *'nottyfast'* *'notf'*
7055'ttyfast' 'tf' boolean (default off, on when 'term' is xterm, hpterm,
7056 sun-cmd, screen, rxvt, dtterm or
7057 iris-ansi; also on when running Vim in
7058 a DOS console)
7059 global
7060 {not in Vi}
7061 Indicates a fast terminal connection. More characters will be sent to
7062 the screen for redrawing, instead of using insert/delete line
7063 commands. Improves smoothness of redrawing when there are multiple
7064 windows and the terminal does not support a scrolling region.
7065 Also enables the extra writing of characters at the end of each screen
7066 line for lines that wrap. This helps when using copy/paste with the
7067 mouse in an xterm and other terminals.
7068
7069 *'ttymouse'* *'ttym'*
7070'ttymouse' 'ttym' string (default depends on 'term')
7071 global
7072 {not in Vi}
7073 {only in Unix and VMS, doesn't work in the GUI; not
7074 available when compiled without |+mouse|}
7075 Name of the terminal type for which mouse codes are to be recognized.
Bram Moolenaar2c7a7632007-05-10 18:19:11 +00007076 Currently these strings are valid:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007077 *xterm-mouse*
7078 xterm xterm-like mouse handling. The mouse generates
7079 "<Esc>[Mscr", where "scr" is three bytes:
7080 "s" = button state
7081 "c" = column plus 33
7082 "r" = row plus 33
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00007083 This only works up to 223 columns! See "dec" for a
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00007084 solution.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007085 xterm2 Works like "xterm", but with the xterm reporting the
7086 mouse position while the mouse is dragged. This works
7087 much faster and more precise. Your xterm must at
Bram Moolenaarbc7aa852005-03-06 23:38:09 +00007088 least at patchlevel 88 / XFree 3.3.3 for this to
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007089 work. See below for how Vim detects this
7090 automatically.
7091 *netterm-mouse*
7092 netterm NetTerm mouse handling. The mouse generates
7093 "<Esc>}r,c<CR>", where "r,c" are two decimal numbers
7094 for the row and column.
7095 *dec-mouse*
7096 dec DEC terminal mouse handling. The mouse generates a
7097 rather complex sequence, starting with "<Esc>[".
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00007098 This is also available for an Xterm, if it was
7099 configured with "--enable-dec-locator".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007100 *jsbterm-mouse*
7101 jsbterm JSB term mouse handling.
7102 *pterm-mouse*
7103 pterm QNX pterm mouse handling.
7104
7105 The mouse handling must be enabled at compile time |+mouse_xterm|
7106 |+mouse_dec| |+mouse_netterm|.
7107 Only "xterm"(2) is really recognized. NetTerm mouse codes are always
7108 recognized, if enabled at compile time. DEC terminal mouse codes
7109 are recognized if enabled at compile time, and 'ttymouse' is not
7110 "xterm" (because the xterm and dec mouse codes conflict).
7111 This option is automatically set to "xterm", when the 'term' option is
7112 set to a name that starts with "xterm", and 'ttymouse' is not "xterm"
7113 or "xterm2" already. The main use of this option is to set it to
7114 "xterm", when the terminal name doesn't start with "xterm", but it can
7115 handle xterm mouse codes.
7116 The "xterm2" value will be set if the xterm version is reported to be
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00007117 95 or higher. This only works when compiled with the |+termresponse|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007118 feature and if |t_RV| is set to the escape sequence to request the
7119 xterm version number. Otherwise "xterm2" must be set explicitly.
7120 If you do not want 'ttymouse' to be set to "xterm2" automatically, set
7121 t_RV to an empty string: >
7122 :set t_RV=
7123<
7124 *'ttyscroll'* *'tsl'*
7125'ttyscroll' 'tsl' number (default 999)
7126 global
7127 Maximum number of lines to scroll the screen. If there are more lines
7128 to scroll the window is redrawn. For terminals where scrolling is
7129 very slow and redrawing is not slow this can be set to a small number,
7130 e.g., 3, to speed up displaying.
7131
7132 *'ttytype'* *'tty'*
7133'ttytype' 'tty' string (default from $TERM)
7134 global
7135 Alias for 'term', see above.
7136
7137 *'undolevels'* *'ul'*
7138'undolevels' 'ul' number (default 100, 1000 for Unix, VMS,
7139 Win32 and OS/2)
7140 global
7141 {not in Vi}
7142 Maximum number of changes that can be undone. Since undo information
7143 is kept in memory, higher numbers will cause more memory to be used
7144 (nevertheless, a single change can use an unlimited amount of memory).
7145 Set to 0 for Vi compatibility: One level of undo and "u" undoes
7146 itself: >
7147 set ul=0
7148< But you can also get Vi compatibility by including the 'u' flag in
7149 'cpoptions', and still be able to use CTRL-R to repeat undo.
7150 Set to a negative number for no undo at all: >
7151 set ul=-1
7152< This helps when you run out of memory for a single change.
7153 Also see |undo-two-ways|.
7154
7155 *'updatecount'* *'uc'*
7156'updatecount' 'uc' number (default: 200)
7157 global
7158 {not in Vi}
7159 After typing this many characters the swap file will be written to
7160 disk. When zero, no swap file will be created at all (see chapter on
7161 recovery |crash-recovery|). 'updatecount' is set to zero by starting
7162 Vim with the "-n" option, see |startup|. When editing in readonly
7163 mode this option will be initialized to 10000.
7164 The swapfile can be disabled per buffer with |'swapfile'|.
7165 When 'updatecount' is set from zero to non-zero, swap files are
7166 created for all buffers that have 'swapfile' set. When 'updatecount'
7167 is set to zero, existing swap files are not deleted.
7168 Also see |'swapsync'|.
7169 This option has no meaning in buffers where |'buftype'| is "nofile"
7170 or "nowrite".
7171
7172 *'updatetime'* *'ut'*
7173'updatetime' 'ut' number (default 4000)
7174 global
7175 {not in Vi}
7176 If this many milliseconds nothing is typed the swap file will be
7177 written to disk (see |crash-recovery|). Also used for the
7178 |CursorHold| autocommand event.
7179
7180 *'verbose'* *'vbs'*
7181'verbose' 'vbs' number (default 0)
7182 global
7183 {not in Vi, although some versions have a boolean
7184 verbose option}
7185 When bigger than zero, Vim will give messages about what it is doing.
7186 Currently, these messages are given:
7187 >= 1 When the viminfo file is read or written.
7188 >= 2 When a file is ":source"'ed.
Bram Moolenaar87b5ca52006-03-04 21:55:31 +00007189 >= 5 Every searched tags file and include file.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007190 >= 8 Files for which a group of autocommands is executed.
7191 >= 9 Every executed autocommand.
7192 >= 12 Every executed function.
7193 >= 13 When an exception is thrown, caught, finished, or discarded.
7194 >= 14 Anything pending in a ":finally" clause.
7195 >= 15 Every executed Ex command (truncated at 200 characters).
7196
7197 This option can also be set with the "-V" argument. See |-V|.
7198 This option is also set by the |:verbose| command.
7199
Bram Moolenaar5c06f8b2005-05-31 22:14:58 +00007200 When the 'verbosefile' option is set then the verbose messages are not
7201 displayed.
7202
7203 *'verbosefile'* *'vfile'*
7204'verbosefile' 'vfile' string (default empty)
7205 global
7206 {not in Vi}
7207 When not empty all messages are written in a file with this name.
7208 When the file exists messages are appended.
7209 Writing to the file ends when Vim exits or when 'verbosefile' is made
7210 empty.
7211 Setting 'verbosefile' to a new value is like making it empty first.
7212 The difference with |:redir| is that verbose messages are not
7213 displayed when 'verbosefile' is set.
7214
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007215 *'viewdir'* *'vdir'*
7216'viewdir' 'vdir' string (default for Amiga, MS-DOS, OS/2 and Win32:
7217 "$VIM/vimfiles/view",
7218 for Unix: "~/.vim/view",
7219 for Macintosh: "$VIM:vimfiles:view"
7220 for VMS: "sys$login:vimfiles/view"
7221 for RiscOS: "Choices:vimfiles/view")
7222 global
7223 {not in Vi}
7224 {not available when compiled without the +mksession
7225 feature}
7226 Name of the directory where to store files for |:mkview|.
7227 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
7228 security reasons.
7229
7230 *'viewoptions'* *'vop'*
7231'viewoptions' 'vop' string (default: "folds,options,cursor")
7232 global
7233 {not in Vi}
7234 {not available when compiled without the +mksession
7235 feature}
7236 Changes the effect of the |:mkview| command. It is a comma separated
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007237 list of words. Each word enables saving and restoring something:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007238 word save and restore ~
7239 cursor cursor position in file and in window
7240 folds manually created folds, opened/closed folds and local
7241 fold options
7242 options options and mappings local to a window or buffer (not
7243 global values for local options)
7244 slash backslashes in file names replaced with forward
7245 slashes
7246 unix with Unix end-of-line format (single <NL>), even when
7247 on Windows or DOS
7248
7249 "slash" and "unix" are useful on Windows when sharing view files
7250 with Unix. The Unix version of Vim cannot source dos format scripts,
7251 but the Windows version of Vim can source unix format scripts.
7252
7253 *'viminfo'* *'vi'* *E526* *E527* *E528*
7254'viminfo' 'vi' string (Vi default: "", Vim default for MS-DOS,
7255 Windows and OS/2: '20,<50,s10,h,rA:,rB:,
7256 for Amiga: '20,<50,s10,h,rdf0:,rdf1:,rdf2:
7257 for others: '20,<50,s10,h)
7258 global
7259 {not in Vi}
7260 {not available when compiled without the |+viminfo|
7261 feature}
7262 When non-empty, the viminfo file is read upon startup and written
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007263 when exiting Vim (see |viminfo-file|). The string should be a comma
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007264 separated list of parameters, each consisting of a single character
7265 identifying the particular parameter, followed by a number or string
7266 which specifies the value of that parameter. If a particular
7267 character is left out, then the default value is used for that
7268 parameter. The following is a list of the identifying characters and
7269 the effect of their value.
7270 CHAR VALUE ~
7271 ! When included, save and restore global variables that start
7272 with an uppercase letter, and don't contain a lowercase
7273 letter. Thus "KEEPTHIS and "K_L_M" are stored, but "KeepThis"
Bram Moolenaar12805862005-01-05 22:16:17 +00007274 and "_K_L_M" are not. Only String and Number types are
7275 stored.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007276 " Maximum number of lines saved for each register. Old name of
7277 the '<' item, with the disadvantage that you need to put a
7278 backslash before the ", otherwise it will be recognized as the
7279 start of a comment!
7280 % When included, save and restore the buffer list. If Vim is
7281 started with a file name argument, the buffer list is not
7282 restored. If Vim is started without a file name argument, the
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007283 buffer list is restored from the viminfo file. Buffers
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007284 without a file name and buffers for help files are not written
7285 to the viminfo file.
Bram Moolenaar15d0a8c2004-09-06 17:44:46 +00007286 When followed by a number, the number specifies the maximum
7287 number of buffers that are stored. Without a number all
7288 buffers are stored.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007289 ' Maximum number of previously edited files for which the marks
7290 are remembered. This parameter must always be included when
7291 'viminfo' is non-empty.
7292 Including this item also means that the |jumplist| and the
7293 |changelist| are stored in the viminfo file.
7294 / Maximum number of items in the search pattern history to be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007295 saved. If non-zero, then the previous search and substitute
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007296 patterns are also saved. When not included, the value of
7297 'history' is used.
7298 : Maximum number of items in the command-line history to be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007299 saved. When not included, the value of 'history' is used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007300 < Maximum number of lines saved for each register. If zero then
7301 registers are not saved. When not included, all lines are
7302 saved. '"' is the old name for this item.
7303 Also see the 's' item below: limit specified in Kbyte.
7304 @ Maximum number of items in the input-line history to be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007305 saved. When not included, the value of 'history' is used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007306 c When included, convert the text in the viminfo file from the
7307 'encoding' used when writing the file to the current
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00007308 'encoding'. See |viminfo-encoding|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007309 f Whether file marks need to be stored. If zero, file marks ('0
7310 to '9, 'A to 'Z) are not stored. When not present or when
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007311 non-zero, they are all stored. '0 is used for the current
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007312 cursor position (when exiting or when doing ":wviminfo").
7313 h Disable the effect of 'hlsearch' when loading the viminfo
7314 file. When not included, it depends on whether ":nohlsearch"
7315 has been used since the last search command.
7316 n Name of the viminfo file. The name must immediately follow
7317 the 'n'. Must be the last one! If the "-i" argument was
7318 given when starting Vim, that file name overrides the one
7319 given here with 'viminfo'. Environment variables are expanded
7320 when opening the file, not when setting the option.
7321 r Removable media. The argument is a string (up to the next
7322 ','). This parameter can be given several times. Each
7323 specifies the start of a path for which no marks will be
7324 stored. This is to avoid removable media. For MS-DOS you
7325 could use "ra:,rb:", for Amiga "rdf0:,rdf1:,rdf2:". You can
7326 also use it for temp files, e.g., for Unix: "r/tmp". Case is
7327 ignored. Maximum length of each 'r' argument is 50
7328 characters.
7329 s Maximum size of an item in Kbyte. If zero then registers are
7330 not saved. Currently only applies to registers. The default
7331 "s10" will exclude registers with more than 10 Kbyte of text.
7332 Also see the '<' item above: line count limit.
7333
7334 Example: >
7335 :set viminfo='50,<1000,s100,:0,n~/vim/viminfo
7336<
7337 '50 Marks will be remembered for the last 50 files you
7338 edited.
7339 <1000 Contents of registers (up to 1000 lines each) will be
7340 remembered.
7341 s100 Registers with more than 100 Kbyte text are skipped.
7342 :0 Command-line history will not be saved.
7343 n~/vim/viminfo The name of the file to use is "~/vim/viminfo".
7344 no / Since '/' is not specified, the default will be used,
7345 that is, save all of the search history, and also the
7346 previous search and substitute patterns.
7347 no % The buffer list will not be saved nor read back.
7348 no h 'hlsearch' highlighting will be restored.
7349
7350 When setting 'viminfo' from an empty value you can use |:rviminfo| to
7351 load the contents of the file, this is not done automatically.
7352
7353 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
7354 security reasons.
7355
7356 *'virtualedit'* *'ve'*
7357'virtualedit' 've' string (default "")
7358 global
7359 {not in Vi}
7360 {not available when compiled without the
7361 |+virtualedit| feature}
7362 A comma separated list of these words:
7363 block Allow virtual editing in Visual block mode.
7364 insert Allow virtual editing in Insert mode.
7365 all Allow virtual editing in all modes.
Bram Moolenaarefd2bf12006-03-16 21:41:35 +00007366 onemore Allow the cursor to move just past the end of the line
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00007367
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007368 Virtual editing means that the cursor can be positioned where there is
Bram Moolenaarebcbd022007-05-12 14:28:25 +00007369 no actual character. This can be halfway into a tab or beyond the end
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007370 of the line. Useful for selecting a rectangle in Visual mode and
7371 editing a table.
Bram Moolenaarefd2bf12006-03-16 21:41:35 +00007372 "onemore" is not the same, it will only allow moving the cursor just
7373 after the last character of the line. This makes some commands more
7374 consistent. Previously the cursor was always past the end of the line
7375 if the line was empty. But it is far from Vi compatible. It may also
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00007376 break some plugins or Vim scripts. For example because |l| can move
7377 the cursor after the last character. Use with care!
7378 Using the |$| command will move to the last character in the line, not
7379 past it. This may actually move the cursor to the left!
Bram Moolenaarefd2bf12006-03-16 21:41:35 +00007380 It doesn't make sense to combine "all" with "onemore", but you will
7381 not get a warning for it.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007382
7383 *'visualbell'* *'vb'* *'novisualbell'* *'novb'* *beep*
7384'visualbell' 'vb' boolean (default off)
7385 global
7386 {not in Vi}
7387 Use visual bell instead of beeping. The terminal code to display the
7388 visual bell is given with 't_vb'. When no beep or flash is wanted,
7389 use ":set vb t_vb=".
7390 Note: When the GUI starts, 't_vb' is reset to its default value. You
7391 might want to set it again in your |gvimrc|.
7392 In the GUI, 't_vb' defaults to "<Esc>|f", which inverts the display
7393 for 20 msec. If you want to use a different time, use "<Esc>|40f",
7394 where 40 is the time in msec.
7395 Does not work on the Amiga, you always get a screen flash.
7396 Also see 'errorbells'.
7397
7398 *'warn'* *'nowarn'*
7399'warn' boolean (default on)
7400 global
7401 Give a warning message when a shell command is used while the buffer
7402 has been changed.
7403
7404 *'weirdinvert'* *'wiv'* *'noweirdinvert'* *'nowiv'*
7405'weirdinvert' 'wiv' boolean (default off)
7406 global
7407 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +00007408 This option has the same effect as the 't_xs' terminal option.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007409 It is provided for backwards compatibility with version 4.x.
7410 Setting 'weirdinvert' has the effect of making 't_xs' non-empty, and
7411 vice versa. Has no effect when the GUI is running.
7412
7413 *'whichwrap'* *'ww'*
7414'whichwrap' 'ww' string (Vim default: "b,s", Vi default: "")
7415 global
7416 {not in Vi}
7417 Allow specified keys that move the cursor left/right to move to the
7418 previous/next line when the cursor is on the first/last character in
7419 the line. Concatenate characters to allow this for these keys:
7420 char key mode ~
7421 b <BS> Normal and Visual
7422 s <Space> Normal and Visual
Bram Moolenaar87b5ca52006-03-04 21:55:31 +00007423 h "h" Normal and Visual (not recommended)
7424 l "l" Normal and Visual (not recommended)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007425 < <Left> Normal and Visual
7426 > <Right> Normal and Visual
7427 ~ "~" Normal
7428 [ <Left> Insert and Replace
7429 ] <Right> Insert and Replace
7430 For example: >
7431 :set ww=<,>,[,]
7432< allows wrap only when cursor keys are used.
7433 When the movement keys are used in combination with a delete or change
7434 operator, the <EOL> also counts for a character. This makes "3h"
7435 different from "3dh" when the cursor crosses the end of a line. This
7436 is also true for "x" and "X", because they do the same as "dl" and
7437 "dh". If you use this, you may also want to use the mapping
7438 ":map <BS> X" to make backspace delete the character in front of the
7439 cursor.
Bram Moolenaar362e1a32006-03-06 23:29:24 +00007440 When 'l' is included and it is used after an operator at the end of a
7441 line then it will not move to the next line. This makes "dl", "cl",
7442 "yl" etc. work normally.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007443 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
7444 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
7445
7446 *'wildchar'* *'wc'*
7447'wildchar' 'wc' number (Vim default: <Tab>, Vi default: CTRL-E)
7448 global
7449 {not in Vi}
7450 Character you have to type to start wildcard expansion in the
7451 command-line, as specified with 'wildmode'.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00007452 More info here: |cmdline-completion|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007453 The character is not recognized when used inside a macro. See
7454 'wildcharm' for that.
7455 Although 'wc' is a number option, you can set it to a special key: >
7456 :set wc=<Esc>
7457< NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
7458 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
7459
7460 *'wildcharm'* *'wcm'*
7461'wildcharm' 'wcm' number (default: none (0))
7462 global
7463 {not in Vi}
7464 'wildcharm' works exactly like 'wildchar', except that it is
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00007465 recognized when used inside a macro. You can find "spare" command-line
7466 keys suitable for this option by looking at |ex-edit-index|. Normally
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007467 you'll never actually type 'wildcharm', just use it in mappings that
7468 automatically invoke completion mode, e.g.: >
7469 :set wcm=<C-Z>
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00007470 :cnoremap ss so $vim/sessions/*.vim<C-Z>
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007471< Then after typing :ss you can use CTRL-P & CTRL-N.
7472
7473 *'wildignore'* *'wig'*
7474'wildignore' 'wig' string (default "")
7475 global
7476 {not in Vi}
7477 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore|
7478 feature}
7479 A list of file patterns. A file that matches with one of these
Bram Moolenaarbb5ddda2008-11-28 10:01:10 +00007480 patterns is ignored when completing file or directory names, and
7481 influences the result of |expand()|, |glob()| and |globpath()| unless
7482 a flag is passed to disable this.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007483 The pattern is used like with |:autocmd|, see |autocmd-patterns|.
7484 Also see 'suffixes'.
7485 Example: >
7486 :set wildignore=*.o,*.obj
7487< The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
7488 a pattern from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
7489 uses another default.
7490
7491 *'wildmenu'* *'wmnu'* *'nowildmenu'* *'nowmnu'*
7492'wildmenu' 'wmnu' boolean (default off)
7493 global
7494 {not in Vi}
7495 {not available if compiled without the |+wildmenu|
7496 feature}
7497 When 'wildmenu' is on, command-line completion operates in an enhanced
7498 mode. On pressing 'wildchar' (usually <Tab>) to invoke completion,
7499 the possible matches are shown just above the command line, with the
7500 first match highlighted (overwriting the status line, if there is
7501 one). Keys that show the previous/next match, such as <Tab> or
7502 CTRL-P/CTRL-N, cause the highlight to move to the appropriate match.
7503 When 'wildmode' is used, "wildmenu" mode is used where "full" is
7504 specified. "longest" and "list" do not start "wildmenu" mode.
7505 If there are more matches than can fit in the line, a ">" is shown on
7506 the right and/or a "<" is shown on the left. The status line scrolls
7507 as needed.
7508 The "wildmenu" mode is abandoned when a key is hit that is not used
7509 for selecting a completion.
7510 While the "wildmenu" is active the following keys have special
7511 meanings:
7512
7513 <Left> <Right> - select previous/next match (like CTRL-P/CTRL-N)
7514 <Down> - in filename/menu name completion: move into a
7515 subdirectory or submenu.
7516 <CR> - in menu completion, when the cursor is just after a
7517 dot: move into a submenu.
7518 <Up> - in filename/menu name completion: move up into
7519 parent directory or parent menu.
7520
7521 This makes the menus accessible from the console |console-menus|.
7522
7523 If you prefer the <Left> and <Right> keys to move the cursor instead
7524 of selecting a different match, use this: >
7525 :cnoremap <Left> <Space><BS><Left>
7526 :cnoremap <Right> <Space><BS><Right>
7527<
7528 The "WildMenu" highlighting is used for displaying the current match
7529 |hl-WildMenu|.
7530
7531 *'wildmode'* *'wim'*
7532'wildmode' 'wim' string (Vim default: "full")
7533 global
7534 {not in Vi}
7535 Completion mode that is used for the character specified with
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007536 'wildchar'. It is a comma separated list of up to four parts. Each
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00007537 part specifies what to do for each consecutive use of 'wildchar'. The
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007538 first part specifies the behavior for the first use of 'wildchar',
7539 The second part for the second use, etc.
7540 These are the possible values for each part:
7541 "" Complete only the first match.
7542 "full" Complete the next full match. After the last match,
7543 the original string is used and then the first match
7544 again.
7545 "longest" Complete till longest common string. If this doesn't
7546 result in a longer string, use the next part.
7547 "longest:full" Like "longest", but also start 'wildmenu' if it is
7548 enabled.
7549 "list" When more than one match, list all matches.
7550 "list:full" When more than one match, list all matches and
7551 complete first match.
7552 "list:longest" When more than one match, list all matches and
7553 complete till longest common string.
7554 When there is only a single match, it is fully completed in all cases.
7555
7556 Examples: >
7557 :set wildmode=full
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00007558< Complete first full match, next match, etc. (the default) >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007559 :set wildmode=longest,full
7560< Complete longest common string, then each full match >
7561 :set wildmode=list:full
7562< List all matches and complete each full match >
7563 :set wildmode=list,full
7564< List all matches without completing, then each full match >
7565 :set wildmode=longest,list
7566< Complete longest common string, then list alternatives.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00007567 More info here: |cmdline-completion|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007568
Bram Moolenaarb5bf5b82004-12-24 14:35:23 +00007569 *'wildoptions'* *'wop'*
7570'wildoptions' 'wop' string (default "")
7571 global
7572 {not in Vi}
7573 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore|
7574 feature}
7575 A list of words that change how command line completion is done.
7576 Currently only one word is allowed:
7577 tagfile When using CTRL-D to list matching tags, the kind of
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00007578 tag and the file of the tag is listed. Only one match
Bram Moolenaarb5bf5b82004-12-24 14:35:23 +00007579 is displayed per line. Often used tag kinds are:
7580 d #define
7581 f function
7582 Also see |cmdline-completion|.
7583
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007584 *'winaltkeys'* *'wak'*
7585'winaltkeys' 'wak' string (default "menu")
7586 global
7587 {not in Vi}
7588 {only used in Win32, Motif, GTK and Photon GUI}
7589 Some GUI versions allow the access to menu entries by using the ALT
7590 key in combination with a character that appears underlined in the
7591 menu. This conflicts with the use of the ALT key for mappings and
7592 entering special characters. This option tells what to do:
7593 no Don't use ALT keys for menus. ALT key combinations can be
7594 mapped, but there is no automatic handling. This can then be
7595 done with the |:simalt| command.
7596 yes ALT key handling is done by the windowing system. ALT key
7597 combinations cannot be mapped.
7598 menu Using ALT in combination with a character that is a menu
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007599 shortcut key, will be handled by the windowing system. Other
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007600 keys can be mapped.
7601 If the menu is disabled by excluding 'm' from 'guioptions', the ALT
7602 key is never used for the menu.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00007603 This option is not used for <F10>; on Win32 and with GTK <F10> will
7604 select the menu, unless it has been mapped.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007605
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00007606 *'window'* *'wi'*
7607'window' 'wi' number (default screen height - 1)
7608 global
7609 Window height. Do not confuse this with the height of the Vim window,
7610 use 'lines' for that.
Bram Moolenaar19a09a12005-03-04 23:39:37 +00007611 Used for |CTRL-F| and |CTRL-B| when there is only one window and the
7612 value is smaller than 'lines' minus one. The screen will scroll
7613 'window' minus two lines, with a minimum of one.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00007614 When 'window' is equal to 'lines' minus one CTRL-F and CTRL-B scroll
7615 in a much smarter way, taking care of wrapping lines.
7616 When resizing the Vim window, the value is smaller than 1 or more than
7617 or equal to 'lines' it will be set to 'lines' minus 1.
7618 {Vi also uses the option to specify the number of displayed lines}
7619
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007620 *'winheight'* *'wh'* *E591*
7621'winheight' 'wh' number (default 1)
7622 global
7623 {not in Vi}
7624 {not available when compiled without the +windows
7625 feature}
7626 Minimal number of lines for the current window. This is not a hard
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007627 minimum, Vim will use fewer lines if there is not enough room. If the
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00007628 focus goes to a window that is smaller, its size is increased, at the
7629 cost of the height of other windows.
7630 Set 'winheight' to a small number for normal editing.
7631 Set it to 999 to make the current window fill most of the screen.
7632 Other windows will be only 'winminheight' high. This has the drawback
7633 that ":all" will create only two windows. To avoid "vim -o 1 2 3 4"
7634 to create only two windows, set the option after startup is done,
7635 using the |VimEnter| event: >
7636 au VimEnter * set winheight=999
7637< Minimum value is 1.
7638 The height is not adjusted after one of the commands that change the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007639 height of the current window.
7640 'winheight' applies to the current window. Use 'winminheight' to set
7641 the minimal height for other windows.
7642
7643 *'winfixheight'* *'wfh'* *'nowinfixheight'* *'nowfh'*
7644'winfixheight' 'wfh' boolean (default off)
7645 local to window
7646 {not in Vi}
7647 {not available when compiled without the +windows
7648 feature}
7649 Keep the window height when windows are opened or closed and
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00007650 'equalalways' is set. Also for |CTRL-W_=|. Set by default for the
7651 |preview-window| and |quickfix-window|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007652 The height may be changed anyway when running out of room.
7653
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00007654 *'winfixwidth'* *'wfw'* *'nowinfixwidth'* *'nowfw'*
7655'winfixwidth' 'wfw' boolean (default off)
7656 local to window
7657 {not in Vi}
7658 {not available when compiled without the +windows
7659 feature}
7660 Keep the window width when windows are opened or closed and
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00007661 'equalalways' is set. Also for |CTRL-W_=|.
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00007662 The width may be changed anyway when running out of room.
7663
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007664 *'winminheight'* *'wmh'*
7665'winminheight' 'wmh' number (default 1)
7666 global
7667 {not in Vi}
7668 {not available when compiled without the +windows
7669 feature}
7670 The minimal height of a window, when it's not the current window.
7671 This is a hard minimum, windows will never become smaller.
7672 When set to zero, windows may be "squashed" to zero lines (i.e. just a
7673 status bar) if necessary. They will return to at least one line when
7674 they become active (since the cursor has to have somewhere to go.)
7675 Use 'winheight' to set the minimal height of the current window.
7676 This option is only checked when making a window smaller. Don't use a
7677 large number, it will cause errors when opening more than a few
7678 windows. A value of 0 to 3 is reasonable.
7679
7680 *'winminwidth'* *'wmw'*
7681'winminwidth' 'wmw' number (default 1)
7682 global
7683 {not in Vi}
7684 {not available when compiled without the +vertsplit
7685 feature}
7686 The minimal width of a window, when it's not the current window.
7687 This is a hard minimum, windows will never become smaller.
7688 When set to zero, windows may be "squashed" to zero columns (i.e. just
7689 a vertical separator) if necessary. They will return to at least one
7690 line when they become active (since the cursor has to have somewhere
7691 to go.)
7692 Use 'winwidth' to set the minimal width of the current window.
7693 This option is only checked when making a window smaller. Don't use a
7694 large number, it will cause errors when opening more than a few
7695 windows. A value of 0 to 12 is reasonable.
7696
7697 *'winwidth'* *'wiw'* *E592*
7698'winwidth' 'wiw' number (default 20)
7699 global
7700 {not in Vi}
7701 {not available when compiled without the +vertsplit
7702 feature}
7703 Minimal number of columns for the current window. This is not a hard
7704 minimum, Vim will use fewer columns if there is not enough room. If
7705 the current window is smaller, its size is increased, at the cost of
7706 the width of other windows. Set it to 999 to make the current window
7707 always fill the screen. Set it to a small number for normal editing.
7708 The width is not adjusted after one of the commands to change the
7709 width of the current window.
7710 'winwidth' applies to the current window. Use 'winminwidth' to set
7711 the minimal width for other windows.
7712
7713 *'wrap'* *'nowrap'*
7714'wrap' boolean (default on)
7715 local to window
7716 {not in Vi}
7717 This option changes how text is displayed. It doesn't change the text
7718 in the buffer, see 'textwidth' for that.
7719 When on, lines longer than the width of the window will wrap and
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007720 displaying continues on the next line. When off lines will not wrap
7721 and only part of long lines will be displayed. When the cursor is
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007722 moved to a part that is not shown, the screen will scroll
7723 horizontally.
7724 The line will be broken in the middle of a word if necessary. See
7725 'linebreak' to get the break at a word boundary.
7726 To make scrolling horizontally a bit more useful, try this: >
7727 :set sidescroll=5
7728 :set listchars+=precedes:<,extends:>
7729< See 'sidescroll', 'listchars' and |wrap-off|.
7730
7731 *'wrapmargin'* *'wm'*
7732'wrapmargin' 'wm' number (default 0)
7733 local to buffer
7734 Number of characters from the right window border where wrapping
7735 starts. When typing text beyond this limit, an <EOL> will be inserted
7736 and inserting continues on the next line.
7737 Options that add a margin, such as 'number' and 'foldcolumn', cause
7738 the text width to be further reduced. This is Vi compatible.
7739 When 'textwidth' is non-zero, this option is not used.
7740 See also 'formatoptions' and |ins-textwidth|. {Vi: works differently
7741 and less usefully}
7742
7743 *'wrapscan'* *'ws'* *'nowrapscan'* *'nows'*
7744'wrapscan' 'ws' boolean (default on) *E384* *E385*
7745 global
Bram Moolenaarac6e65f2005-08-29 22:25:38 +00007746 Searches wrap around the end of the file. Also applies to |]s| and
7747 |[s|, searching for spelling mistakes.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007748
7749 *'write'* *'nowrite'*
7750'write' boolean (default on)
7751 global
7752 {not in Vi}
7753 Allows writing files. When not set, writing a file is not allowed.
7754 Can be used for a view-only mode, where modifications to the text are
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007755 still allowed. Can be reset with the |-m| or |-M| command line
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007756 argument. Filtering text is still possible, even though this requires
7757 writing a temporary file.
7758
7759 *'writeany'* *'wa'* *'nowriteany'* *'nowa'*
7760'writeany' 'wa' boolean (default off)
7761 global
7762 Allows writing to any file with no need for "!" override.
7763
7764 *'writebackup'* *'wb'* *'nowritebackup'* *'nowb'*
7765'writebackup' 'wb' boolean (default on with |+writebackup| feature, off
7766 otherwise)
7767 global
7768 {not in Vi}
7769 Make a backup before overwriting a file. The backup is removed after
7770 the file was successfully written, unless the 'backup' option is
7771 also on. Reset this option if your file system is almost full. See
7772 |backup-table| for another explanation.
7773 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a backup is not made anyway.
7774 NOTE: This option is set to the default value when 'compatible' is
7775 set.
7776
7777 *'writedelay'* *'wd'*
7778'writedelay' 'wd' number (default 0)
7779 global
7780 {not in Vi}
7781 The number of microseconds to wait for each character sent to the
7782 screen. When non-zero, characters are sent to the terminal one by
7783 one. For MS-DOS pcterm this does not work. For debugging purposes.
7784
7785 vim:tw=78:ts=8:ft=help:norl: